Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Users Guide
TOTAL
CUSTOMER
SATISFACTION
3 Year Warranty
ISO 9001
1241 Bundy Boulevard., Winona, Minnesota USA 55987
Phone: +1 (507) 454-5300, Fax: +1 (507) 452-4507
http://www.watlow.com
0600-0059-0000 Rev. P
August 2016
Registered Company
Winona, Minnesota USA
Safety Information
We use note, caution and warning symbols throughout this book to draw your attention to
important operational and safety information.
A NOTE marks a short message to alert you to an important detail.
A CAUTION safety alert appears with information that is important for protecting your
equipment and performance. Be especially careful to read and follow all cautions that
apply to your application.
A WARNING safety alert appears with information that is important for protecting you,
others and equipment from damage. Pay very close attention to all warnings that apply to
your application.
The safety alert symbol,
(an exclamation point in a triangle) precedes a general
CAUTION or WARNING statement.
The electrical hazard symbol,
(a lightning bolt in a triangle) precedes an electric shock
hazard CAUTION or WARNING safety statement. Further explanations follow:
Symbol
Explanation
CAUTION Warning or Hazard that needs further explanation than
label on unit can provide. Consult User's Guide for further information.
ESD Sensitive product, use proper grounding and handling techniques
when installing or servicing product.
Unit protected by double/reinforced insulation for shock hazard prevention.
Do not throw in trash, use proper recycling techniques or consult
manufacturer for proper disposal.
Enclosure made of Polycarbonate material. Use proper recycling
techniques or consult manufacturer for proper disposal.
Unit can be powered with either alternating current (ac) voltage or
direct current (dc) voltage.
Unit is a Listed device per Underwriters Laboratories. It has been
evaluated to United States and Canadian requirements for Process
Control Equipment. UL 61010 and CSA C22.2 No. 61010. File E185611
QUYX, QUYX7. See: www.ul.com
Unit is a Listed device per Underwriters Laboratories. It has been
evaluated to United States and Canadian requirements for Hazardous
Locations Class 1 Division II Groups A, B, C and D. ANSI/ISA 12.12.012007. File E184390 QUZW, QUZW7. See: www.ul.com
Warranty
The EZ-ZONE PM is manufactured by ISO 9001-registered processes and is backed by a
three-year warranty to the first purchaser for use, providing that the units have not been
misapplied. Since Watlow has no control over their use, and sometimes misuse, we cannot
guarantee against failure. Watlow's obligations hereunder, at Watlow's option, are limited to
replacement, repair or refund of purchase price, and parts which upon examination prove to
be defective within the warranty period specified. This warranty does not apply to damage
resulting from transportation, alteration, misuse or abuse. The purchaser must use Watlow
parts to maintain all listed ratings.
Technical Assistance
If you encounter a problem with your Watlow controller, review your configuration information to verify that your selections are consistent with your application: inputs, outputs,
alarms, limits, etc. If the problem persists, you can get technical assistance from your local
Watlow representative (see back cover), by e-mailing your questions to wintechsupport@watlow.com or by dialing +1 (507) 494-5656 between 7 a.m. and 5 p.m., Central Standard Time
(CST). Ask for for an Applications Engineer. Please have the following information available
when calling:
Complete model number
All configuration information
Users Guide
Factory Page
Phone number
Method of return shipment
Your P.O. number
Detailed description of the problem
Any special instructions
Name and phone number of person returning the product.
2. Prior approval and an Return Merchandise Authorization number from the Customer
Service Department is required when returning any product for credit, repair or evaluation. Make sure the Return Merchandise Authorization number is on the outside of the carton and on all paperwork returned. Ship on a Freight Prepaid basis.
3. After we receive your return, we will examine it and try to verify the reason for returning
it.
4. In cases of manufacturing defect, we will enter a repair order, replacement order or issue
credit for material returned. In cases of customer misuse, we will provide repair costs and
request a purchase order to proceed with the repair work.
5. To return products that are not defective, goods must be in new condition, in the original boxes and they must be returned within 120 days of receipt. A 20 percent restocking
charge is applied for all returned stock controls and accessories.
6. If the unit cannot be repaired, you will receive a letter of explanation and be given the
option to have the unit returned to you at your expense or to have us scrap the unit.
7. Watlow reserves the right to charge for no trouble found (NTF) returns.
This EZ-ZONE PM Users Guide is copyrighted by Watlow Electric, Inc., August 2016 with all
rights reserved.
EZ-ZONE PM is covered by U.S. Patent Numbers: 6005577; D553095; D553096; D553097;
D560175; D55766; and OTHER PATENTS PENDING
TC
Table of Contents
Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Chapter 1: Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Available EZ-ZONE PM Literature and Resources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Getting Started Quickly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
A Conceptual View of the PM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Internal Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Outputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Input Events and Output Events. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
What is a Profile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Ta ble of C o n te n ts
TC
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Ta ble of C o n te n ts
TC
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Ta ble of C o n te n ts
TC
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Ta ble of C o n te n ts
TC
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Ta ble of C o n te n ts
Chapter 1: Overview
Description
Describes how to connect and use an advanced PID loop
controller. This particular model is limited to one control loop and 2 outputs. Like all PM controllers, it comes
with Standard Bus communications. As an additional
option, it can also be ordered with Modbus RTU communications.
This document describes how to protect against unwanted thermal runaway and over temperature conditions through proper configuration, programming. Like
all PM controllers, it comes with Standard Bus communications. As an additional option, it can also be ordered
with various fieldbus communications protocols.
The RUI provides a visual remote LED display for the
PM/RM configuration and setup menus. This document
illustrates and describes connections and also describes
the Home Page for each EZ-ZONE device as viewed from
the RUI.
Describes the PM family hardware options, features,
benefits and technical specifications.
Contains all related user documents, tutorial videos, application notes, utility tools, etc...
The DVD described above ships with the product and as stated contains all of the literature
above as well as much more. If the DVD is not available one can be acquired by contacting
Watlow Customer Service at 1-507-454-5300.
As an alternative to the DVD, all of the user documentation described above can also be
found on the Watlow website. Click on the following link to find your document of choice:
http://www.watlow.com/en/resources-and-support/Technical-Library/User-Manuals. Once
there, simply type in the desired part number (or name) into the search box and download
free copies. Printed versions of all user documents can also be purchased here as well.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
Introduction
The EZ-ZONE PM takes the pain out of solving your thermal loop requirements. Watlows
EZ-ZONE PM controllers offer options to reduce system complexity and the cost of control
loop ownership. You can order the EZ-ZONE PM as a PID controller or an over-under limit controller, or you can combine both functions in the PM Integrated Controller. You now have the
option to integrate a high-amperage power controller output, an over-under limit controller
and a high-performance PID controller all in space saving, panel-mount packages. You can
also select from a number of industrial serial communications options to help you manage
system performance.
Agency approvals: UL Listed, CSA, CE, RoHS, W.E.E.E. FM, SEMI F47-0200, Class 1, Div 2
rating on selected models
Assures prompt product acceptance
Reduces end product documentation costs
EZ-Key/s
Programmable EZ-Key enables simple one-touch operation of repetitive user activities
Three-year warranty
Demonstrates Watlow's reliability and product support
Touch-safe Package
IP2X increased safety for installers and operators
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Heat-Cool Operation
Provides application flexibility with accurate temperature and process control
Reduces wiring time and termination complexity compared to connecting discrete products
Decreases required panel space
Lowers installation costs
Increases user ad equipment safety for over/under temperature conditions
Current Monitoring
Detects heater current flow and provides alarm indication of a failed output device or
heater load
Communications Capabilities
Provides a wide range of protocol choices including Modbus RTU, EtherNet/IPTM, PCCC
(Programmable Controller Communications Commands), DeviceNetTM, Modbus TCP, and
Profibus DP
Supports network connectivity to a PC or PLC
Full-featured Alarms
Improves operator recognition of system faults
Control of auxiliary devices
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
Retransmit Output
Supports industry needs for product process recording
Profile Capability
Pre-programmed process control
Ramp and soak programming with four files and 40 total steps
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Note:
The output cycle time will have a bearing on the life of mechanical relay outputs and can
be different based on the type of output ordered. The output cycle time can be changed
in the Setup Page under the Output Menu.
EZ-ZONE PM Default Configuration
Input
Function
Input Sensor
Process
Value
Analog Input 1
Thermocouple Type J
(PV)
Function
PID
Controller
Heat
Output
Function
Output 1
Heat
Loop 1
Off
Inputs
The inputs provide the information that any given programmed procedure can act upon. In a
simple form, this information may come from an operator pushing a button or from a sensor
monitoring the temperature of a part being heated or cooled.
Each analog input typically uses a thermocouple or RTD to read the process temperature. It
can also read volts, current or resistance, allowing it to use various devices to read a wide
array of values.
A PM with digital input/output (DIO) hardware includes two sets of terminals where each of
which can be used as either an input or an output. Each pair of terminals must be configured
to function as either an input or output with the direction parameter in the Digital Input/
Output Menu (Setup Page). Each digital input reads whether a device is active or inactive.
The Function or EZ Key/s (PM4/6/8/9 only) on the front panel of the PM also operates as a
digital input by toggling the function assigned to it in the Digital Input Function parameter in
the Function Key Menu (Setup Page).
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
10
Internal Functions
The controller will use input signals to calculate a value and then perform an operation. A
sample of some functions may be as simple as:
Compare an input value to the set point and calculate the optimal power for a heater
Detect a failure of the primary sensing device and trip a contactor to remove power from
the heating element
Reading a digital input to set a state to true or false
Evaluate an incoming temperature to determine an alarm state (on or off)
To set up a function, its important to define the source, or instance, to use. For example, if
the control is equipped with DIO they can be configured to respond to an alarm. If configured
as such, the digital output must be tied to the desired alarm instance (1 to 4). Using this as
an example, the Function for the digital output would be defined as an Alarm where the Instance would be selected as 1, 2, 3, or 4 corresponding to the alarm instance that will drive
the output.
Keep in mind that a function is a user-programmed internal process that does not execute
any action outside of the controller. To have any effect outside of the controller, an output
must be configured to respond to a function.
Outputs
Outputs can perform various functions or actions in response to information provided by a
function such as, removal of the control voltage to a contactor; operating a heater, turning a
light on or off, unlocking a door, etc...
Assign a Function to any available output on the Setup Page within the Output Menu or Digital Input/Output Menu. Then select which instance of that function will drive the selected
output. For example, you might assign an output to respond to alarm 4 (instance 4).
You can assign more than one output to respond to a single instance of a function. For example, alarm 2 could be used to trigger a light connected to output 1 and a siren connected
to digital output 5.
What is a Profile
A profile is a set of instructions consisting of a sequence of steps. When a profile runs, the
controller automatically executes its steps in sequence. The step type determines what action the controller performs. Steps can change temperatures and other process values gradually over time, maintain the temperatures and process values for specific periods, or repeat
a sequence of steps numerous times. At each step the profile can activate or deactivate
outputs that control other equipment. Also a step can have the controller wait for specific
conditions before proceeding such as, waiting for a switch closure and/or a specific process
value to be detected by a sensor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
11
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Inputs
PID
Controller
Input Sensor
- None
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Force alarm
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control outputs off
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
Slot A
(Optional)
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
EZ Key
Programmable Event
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Modbus
Address
1 - 247
Supervisory &
Power Board
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
Slot C
Current
Transformer
Board
(optional)
Current
Transformer
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Analog Input 2
Current Transformer
Slot B
Output 3
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output Status
Zone
Address
Indicates Zone
Address
Indicates I/O
Status
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Current Monitoring
Detects heater current flow
Provides an alarm indication of a failed-load issue.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
12
Inputs
PID
Controller
Input Sensor
- None
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Force alarm
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control outputs off
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
Slots A
(Optional)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Supervisory &
Power Board
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
Slot C
Auxillary
Input
(optional)
Input Sensor
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Analog Input 2
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Slot B
Output 3
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output Status
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Zone
Address
Indicates Zone
Address
Indicates I/O
Status
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
13
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Inputs
PID
Controller
Input Sensor
- None
- Limit reset
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Force alarm
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control outputs off
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Input Sensor
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
Slots A
(Optional)
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
Analog Input 2
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Supervisory &
Power Board
Slot C
Limit Controller
Board
(optional)
Slot B
Output 3
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 4
5A mechanical relay (form A)
Limit
Zone
Address
Indicates Zone
Address
Indicates I/O
Status
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
14
Inputs
PID
Controller
Input Sensor
- None
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Force alarm
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control outputs off
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
Analog Input 1
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Slot A
(Optional)
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Modbus Address
1 - 247
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Supervisory &
Power Board
Slot C
Communications
Board
Communications
EIA 232/485 Modbus RTU/TCP,
EtherNet/IP, DeviceNet, Profibus,
J1939 CAN bus
Slot B
Output Status
Zone
Address
Indicates Zone
Address
Indicates I/O
Status
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
15
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Input Sensor
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
PID
Controller
Slots A
(Optional)
Input Sensor
- None
- Limit reset
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control mode
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- Force alarm
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
- Math
Analog Input 2
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Power Supply
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector,
5A mechanical relay (form C),
process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 3
PID Controller,
none, switched dc/open collector,
Limit, or Current
5A mechanical relay (form C),
Transformer Sense
process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
(CT)
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Slots B
(Optional)
EZ Key 1 & 2
Programmable Functions
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Output Status
LEDs
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
100 to 240Vac
20 to 28 Vac or 12 to 40Vdc
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Supervisory &
Power Board
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Outputs
LEDs
Zone
Channel
Address
Indicates Zone
Address & Channel
Indicates I/O
Status
Slot C
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
16
Inputs
Input Sensor
Outputs
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
PID
Controller
(Optional Ramp/Soak max
4 files, 40 steps)
Slots A
(Optional)
Input Sensor
Analog Input 2
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
mechanical relay (form C), process
(V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 3
PID Controller, none, switched dc/open collector, 5A
Limit, or
mechanical relay (form C), process
Current Trans- (V, mA), or 0.5A SSR (form A)
former Sense
(CT)
Slots B
(Optional)
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
- None
- Limit reset
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control mode
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- Force alarm
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
- Math
6 - Digital
Inputs / Outputs
Digital Input (or Output) 7-12 (optional)
Programmable Functions
Slot D
(Optional)
EZ Key 1 & 2
Programmable Functions
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Output Status
LEDs
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Power Supply
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
100 to 240Vac
20 to 28 Vac or 12 to 40Vdc
Supervisory &
Power Board
Slot C
LEDs
Zone
Channel
Address
Indicates Zone
Address & Channel
Indicates I/O
Status
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
17
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
EZ-ZONE PM Integrated Model 1/8 and 1/4 DIN with CT System Diagram
Without
6 Digital
(slot D),
(slot E)
EZ-ZONE
PMI/O
Integrated
8thWithout
DIN withCommunications
CT System Diagram
Inputs
Input Sensor
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
PID
Controller
Slots A
(Optional)
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector,
5A mechanical relay (form C),
process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 3
Current Transformer
none, switched dc/open collector,
Sense (CT)
5A mechanical relay (form C),
process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Current
Transformer
- None
- Idle set point
- Tune
- Alarm clear, request
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control mode
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- Force alarm
- TRU-TUNE+ disable
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
- Math
Power Supply
Analog Input 2
Current Transformer
Slots B
(Optional)
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
EZ Key 1 & 2
Programmable Functions
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Output Status
LEDs
EIA-485 Communication
Standard Bus
(optional Modbus RTU)
100 to 240Vac
20 to 28 Vac or 12 to 40Vdc
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Supervisory &
Power Board
RUI, EZ-ZONE
Controllers, PLC, PC
or HMI
Outputs
LEDs
Zone
Channel
Address
Indicates Zone
Address & Channel
Indicates I/O
Status
Slot C
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
18
Input Sensor
Analog Input 1
none, Thermocouple, RTD (100,
1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k, 20k,
40k) Process (V, mV, mA) or 1k
Potentiometer
PID
Controller
Slots A
(Optional)
Input Sensor
Analog Input 2
none, CT, Thermocouple, RTD (100
, 1k), Thermistor 5k, 10k,
20k, 40k) Process (V, mV, mA)
or 1k Potentiometer
Output 1
none, switched dc/open collector,
5A mechanical relay (form C),
process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 2
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Output 3
PID Controller,
none, switched dc/open collector,
Limit, or Current 5A mechanical relay (form C),
Transformer Sense process, or 0.5A SSR (form A)
(CT)
Slots B
(Optional)
Outputs
Output 4
none, 15A NO-ARC, switched dc,
5A mechanical relay (form A), or
0.5A SSR (form A)
Power Supply
- None
- Limit reset
- Idle set point
- Tune, TRU-TUNE+
- Alarm clear, request
- Silence alarm
- Manual/auto mode
- Control mode
- Remote set point
enable
- Lock keypad
- Force alarm
- Loop & alarms off
- Profile disable
- Profile hold/resume
- Profile start
- Profile start/stop
- Restore user settings
- Event inputs
- Math
Slots E
(Optional)
Modbus
Address 1 - 247
Digital Output (or Input) 5 & 6
(optional) none, switched dc
100 to 240Vac
20 to 28 Vac or 12 to 40Vdc
Standard Bus
Zone Address
1 - 16
Output Status
LEDs
Supervisory &
Power Board
EZ Key 1 & 2
Programmable Functions
LEDs
Zone
Channel
Address
Indicates Zone
Address & Channel
Indicates I/O
Status
Slot C
Note:
Number of inputs and outputs and various combinations of the same will vary
depending upon part number; see ordering matrix for more detail.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
19
Cha pte r 1 O v e r v i e w
Dimensions
101.6 mm
(4.00 in)
53.3 mm
(2.10 in)
53.3 mm
(2.10 in)
Side
Front
51.2 mm
(2.02 in)
L1
L3
K1
98
K3
99
J1
J3
CF
L2
L4
CD
K2
K4
CE
T1
T2
B5
S1
S2
D6
R1
R2
D5
Top
Back
44.96 to 45.47 mm
(1.77 to 1.79 inches)
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
minimum
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
minimum
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
20
53.34 mm
(2.10 in)
100.33 mm
(3.95 in)
54.8 mm
(2.16 in)
10.16 mm
(0.40 in)
30.73 mm
(1.21 in)
101.60 mm
(4.00 in)
92.00 to 92.80 mm
(3.62 to 3.65 inches)
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
Minimum
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
Minimum
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
21
100.33 mm
(3.95 in)
53.8 mm
(2.16 in)
53.34 mm
(2.10 in)
10.16 mm
(0.40 in)
30.73 mm
(1.21 in)
101.60 mm
(4.00 in)
44.96 to 45.60 mm
(1.77 to 1.79 inches)
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
Minimum
21.6 mm
(0.85 in)
Minimum
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
22
1.52 mm
(0.06 in)
100.33 mm
(3.95 in)
100.33 mm
(3.95 in)
12.70 mm
(0.50 in)
30.73 mm
(1.21 in)
100.84 mm
(3.97 in)
92.0 to 93.0 mm
(3.62 to 3.65 inches)
21.6 mm
(0.85 inches)
Minimum
21.6 mm
(0.85 inches)
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
23
Installation
1. Make the panel cutout using the mounting template dimensions in this chapter. Insert the
case assembly into the panel cutout.
2. While pressing the case assembly firmly against the
panel, slide the mounting collar over the back of
the controller. If the installation does not require
a NEMA 4X seal, simply slide together until the
gasket is compressed.
3. For a NEMA 4X (UL50, IP65) seal, alternately place
and push the blade of a screwdriver against each
of the the four corners of the mounting collar
assembly. Apply pressure to the face of the controller while pushing with the screwdriver. Don't be
afraid to apply enough pressure to properly install
the controller. The seal system is compressed more
by mating the mounting collar tighter to the front
panel (see pictures above). If you can move the case assembly back and forth in the
cutout, you do not have a proper seal. The tabs on each side of the mounting collar have
teeth that latch into the ridges on the sides of the controller. Each tooth is staggered at a
different depth from the front so that only one of the tabs, on each side, is locked onto
the ridges at a time.
Note:
There is a graduated measurement difference between the upper and lower half of the
display to the panel. In order to meet the seal requirements mentioned above, ensure
that the distance from the front of the top half of the display to the panel is 16 mm
(0.630 in.) or less, and the distance from the front of the bottom half and the panel is
13.3 mm (0.525 in.) or less.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
24
2. Grab the unit above and below the face with two hands and pull the unit out. On the
PM4/8/9 controls slide a screwdriver under the pry tabs and turn.
WARNING!
This equipment is suitable for use in class 1, div. 2, Groups A, B, C and D or Non-Hazardous
locations only. Temperature Code T4A.
WARNING EXPLOSION HAZARD. Substitution of component may impair suitability for class 1,
div. 2.
WARNING EXPLOSION HAZARD. Do not disconnect equipment unless power has been
switched off or the area is known to be nonhazardous.
Chemical Compatibility
This product is compatible with acids, weak alkalis, alcohols, gamma radiation and ultraviolet radiation. This product is not compatible with strong alkalis, organic solvents, fuels,
aromatic hydrocarbons, chlorinated hydrocarbons, esters and keytones.
WARNING!
All electrical power to the controller and controlled circuits must be disconnected before
removing the controller from the front panel or disconnecting other wiring. Failure to follow these instructions may cause an electrical shock and/or sparks that could cause an explosion in class 1, div. 2 hazardous locations.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
25
Wiring
Slot A
Slot B
Slot D Slot E
Terminal Function
Inputs
2
7 - 12
Configuration
T1
T2
S2 (RTD) or current +
S1
S2
R1
R2
S3 (RTD), thermocouple
-, current -, potentiometer wiper, thermistor or
volts S1 (RTD), thermocouple
+, volts +, potentiometer
or thermistor
Input 2: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ [T] _ _ _ _ _
mA ac
mA ac
Digital Inputs 7 - 12
B7
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
Z7
Common
dc +input
dc +input
dc +input
dc +input
dc +input
dc +input
Internal Supply
Outputs
3
4
7 - 12
X1
X3
W1
Y1
W3
Y3
Inputs 7 to 12:
PM[4,8,9] _ _ _ _ - [C,D] _ _ _ _ _ _
Switched dc
W2
Y2
W4
Y4
Output 2: PM _ _ _ _ [C] - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
Output 4: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ [C] _ _ _
dcdc+
Universal Process
F1
G1
H1
F3
G3
H3
L1
K1
J1
L3
K3
J3
Output 1: PM _ _ _ [F] _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
Output 3: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ [F] _ _ _ _
Output 1: PM _ _ _ [E] _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
Output 3: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ [E] _ _ _ _
NO-ARC 15 A, Form A
L2
K2
L4
K4
normally open
common
L4
K4
normally open
common
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
26
Output 2: PM _ _ _ _ [J] - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
Output 4: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ [J] _ _ _
Wiring (cont.)
Slot A
1
L1
K1
L2
K2
Slot B
Slot D Slot E
Terminal Function
Outputs (cont.)
3
4
7 - 12
L3
K3
Configuration
L4
K4
normally open
common
Output
Output
Output
Output
1:
2:
3:
4:
PM
PM
PM
PM
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
[K] _ - _ _ _ _
_ [K] - _ _ _ _
_ _ - _ _ [K] _
_ _ - _ _ _ [K]
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
Digital Outputs
B7
D7
Common
switched dc/open
tor
switched dc/open
tor
switched dc/open
tor
switched dc/open
tor
switched dc/open
tor
switched dc/open
tor
Internal Supply
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
Z7
Communications
collec-
PM[4,8,9] _ _ _ _ - [C, D] _ _ _ _ _ _
colleccolleccolleccolleccollec-
CB
CB
CA
CC
CA
CC
CB
CB
CA
C5
CA
C5
C3
C3
C2
C2
Modbus RTU
R+
Modbus RTU
Modbus RTU
mon
Modbus RTU
R+
Modbus RTU
Modbus RTU
mon
Modbus RTU
DB9 pin 2
Modbus RTU
DB9 pin 3
EIA-485 T+/
EIA-485 T-/REIA-485 com-
EIA-485 T+/
EIA-485 T-/REIA-232 comEIA-232 to
EIA-232 to
DeviceNet Communications
V+
CH
V+
CH
SH
CL
SH
CL
V-
V-
DeviceNet power
Slot B: PM6 _ _ _ _ - [5] A A A _ _ _
Positive side of DeviceNet Slot E: PM[4,8,9] _ _ _ _ - [5] _ _ _ _ _ _
bus
Shield interconnect
Negative side of
DeviceNet bus
DeviceNet power return
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
27
Wiring (cont.)
Slot A
Slot B
Slot D Slot E
Terminal Function
Configuration
Communications (cont.)
E8
E7
E6
E8
E7
E6
E5
E4
E3
E5
E4
E3
E2
E2
E1
E1
unused
unused
EtherNet/IP and
TCP receive unused
unused
EtherNet/IP and
TCP receive +
EtherNet/IP and
TCP transmit EtherNet/IP and
TCP transmit +
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Modbus
Profibus DP Communications
VP
B
A
DG
trB
B
A
trA
VP
B
A
DG
trB
B
A
trA
Voltage Potential
EIA-485 T+/R+
EIA-485 T-/RDigital ground (common)
Termination resistor B
EIA-485 T+/R+
EIA-485 T-/RTermination resistor A
CL
CH
SH
V+
V-
Terminal Function
Power
Configuration
all
PM _ _ _ _ _ - [1] _ _ _ _ _ _
PM _ _ _ _ _ - [A,D,2,3,5] _ _ _
___
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
PM _ _ [2] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
PM _ _ [4] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
28
Power
Output 1
Output 3
Output 2
Output 4
Communications Card
Input 1
Digital I/O 7 - 12
Output 2
Output 3
Input 1
Input 2
Input 2
Power
Output 4
Digital I/O 7 - 12
Output 3
Input 1
Input 1
Output 1
C
B
A
Power
Communications Card
Output 2
Output 4
Digital I/O 7 - 12
Output 3
Power
Output 1
Output 2
Output 1
Input 2
Note:
Slot B above can also be configured with a communications card.
Output 4
29
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
C
E
D
A
D
B
C
E
E
A
D
B
A
Mechanical Relay,
Solid-State Relay,
NO-ARC Relay
Outputs
No Isolation
Safety Isolation
Safety Isolation
No Isolation
Controller
Low Voltage Power Bus
Analog Input 1
No Isolation
Note:
Safety Isolation
Low-voltage
Isolation
Analog Input 2
Low-voltage
Isolation
Communications Ports
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
30
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between analog input 1, digital
input-outputs, switched dc/open
collector outputs and process
outputs to prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4A
Low Power
Minimum/Maximum Ratings
Slot C
power
98
power
99
PM_ _ [3,4] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
fuse
12 to 40V (dc)
20 to 28V (ac) Semi Sig F47
47 to 63 Hz
14VA maximum power consumption (PM4, 8
and 9)
10VA maximum power consumption (PM6)
CF
CD
CE
B5
D6
D5
Power
High Power
Minimum/Maximum Ratings
Slot C
power
98
power
99
PM_ _ [1,2] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
fuse
85 to 264V (ac)
100 to 240V (ac) Semi Sig F47
47 to 63 Hz
14VA maximum power consumption (PM4, 8 and
9)
10VA maximum power consumption (PM6)
CF
CD
CE
B5
D6
D5
Power
Digital Input 5 - 6
Digital Input
Update rate 10 Hz
Dry contact or dc
voltage
Slot C
98
99
CF
CD
CE
B5
D6
D5
PM _ _ [2,4] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
common
DC Input
DC Input
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Dry contact
closure Digital Inputs shall not be
used in Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations unless switch used
is approved for this application.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
Voltage Input
B_
DC Voltage
Input not to exceed
36V (dc) at 3mA
Input active when >
3V (dc) @ 0.25mA
Input inactive when
< 2V
Dry Contact
Input inactive when
> 500
Input active when <
100
Maximum short circuit 13mA
31
common
Vdc
D_
Dry Contact
B_
common
D_
24 Vdc
D8
DC Input
D9
DC Input
D10
DC Input
D11
DC Input
D12
Internal Supply
Z7
Voltage Input
common
B_
Vdc
D_
Dry Contact
D_
24 Vdc
Z_
PM8 - Zone 2
Digital Input
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
Z7
B7
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
Z7
Input 2
Digital I/O 7 - 12
Digital I/O 7 - 12
Output 4
Power
D7
Pull-up resistor
required 1K
to 10K Ohms
Digital Output
Power
B7
Output 3
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
D7
Input 1
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
DC Input
DC Input
Output 2
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Dry contact
closure Digital Inputs shall not be
used in Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations unless switch used
is approved for this application.
B7
PM [4,8,9] _ _ _ _- [C,D] _ _ _ _ _ _
Slot E
Common
Output 1
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between analog input 1, digital
input-outputs, switched dc/open
collector outputs and process
outputs to prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4A
Digital Input 7 - 12
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
32
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between analog input 1, digital
input-outputs, switched dc/open
collector outputs and process
outputs to prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4A
Input 1, 2 Thermocouple
Slot A,B
S_
R_
Input 1, 2 RTD
Slot A,B
Slot A, B
S2
T_
S3
S_
S3
S_
S1
R_
S1
R_
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Dry contact
closure Digital Inputs shall not be
used in Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations unless switch used
is approved for this application.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
33
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between analog input 1, digital
input-outputs, switched dc/open
collector outputs and process
outputs to prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4A
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Dry contact
closure Digital Inputs shall not be
used in Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations unless switch used
is approved for this application.
Input 1, 2 Process
Slot A, B
+ T_
-
- S_
+ R_
S_
volts
amperes
CW
CCW
Use a 1k potentiometer.
Input 1: PM _ [C,R,B*] _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (S1/
R1)
Input 2: PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ [C,R,L] _ _ _ _ _ (S2/
R2)
* PM(4, 8 and 9) only
S_
R_
Input 1, 2 Thermistor
Slot A, B
S_
R_
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Slot A, B
Slot B
PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ [T] _ _ _ _ _
T2
S2
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
34
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Is = IpT/R = 50mA
CSC = Ip(full scale) = 50mA(R)/T
CSI = Output N
L1
Is
Ip
T
R
Fuse
SSR
3A x 4
Turns around CT
Output N
Controller
12A
CT Input
CT Ratio R = 1000:1
48mA
CT Secondary Current
CT Primary Current
Turns around CT
Total current
Digital Output 5 - 6
Slot C
98
99
CF
CD
CE
B5
common
D6 switched dc
D5
switched dc
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
PM _ _ [2,4] _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
Digital Output
SSR drive signal
Update rate 10 Hz
Maximum open circuit voltage is 22 to
25V (dc)
PNP transistor
source
Typical drive; 21mA
@ 4.5V (dc) for
DO5, and 11mA @
4.5V for DO6
Current limit 24mA
for Output 5 and
12mA Output 6
Output 5 capable of
driving one 3-pole
DIN-A-MITE
Output 6 capable of
driving one 1-pole
DIN-A-MITE
35
switched dc outputs
D5
24VDC
D6
B5
Internal Circuitry
Note:
See output curves below.
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
36
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
D5
VDC
Htr 1
Htr 2
D6
B5
DC80-60C0-0000
Internal Circuitry
Digital Output 7 - 12
Slot D
B7
D7
D8
D9
D10
Common
Collector out
Collector out
Collector out
Collector out
D11
Collector out
D12
Collector out
Z7
Internal Supply
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
+
+
-
PM [4,6,8] _ _ _ _- [C,D] _ _ _ _ _ _
D7
D8
D9
VDC
D10
D11
D12
Z7 Internal Supply
Internal Circuitry
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
37
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Internal Supply
Note:
As a switched DC output; this output is a constant current output delivering 750mW, current limited to 400mA. The internal
supply does have a maximum open circuit voltage of 22V
(dc) and minimum open circuit voltage of 19V (dc). Pin Z7 is
shared to all digital outputs. This type of output is meant to
drive solid state relays, not mechanical relays.
As an open collector output, use an external power supply with
the negative wired to B7, the positive to the coil of a pilot mechanical relay and the other side of the coil wired to D_. Each
open collector output can sink 1.5A with the total for all open
collector outputs not exceeding 8A. Ensure that a kickback diode is reversed wired across the relay coil to prevent damage
to the internal transistor.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
Internal Supply
38
Slot A, B
X_
W_
Y_
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Switched DC
Maximum open circuit
voltage is 22 to 25V (dc)
30mA max. per single
output / 40mA max. total
per paired outputs (1 & 2,
3 & 4)
Switched DC
Limit Control
Contacts
(If Required)
L2
L1
Heater
Semiconductor
Fuse
1() (+)2
4() (+)3
Switched DC
X_ common
W_
dc -
(-)
(+)
Y_
dc +
X_
W_
24VDC
Y_
voltage
Any switched dc output
can use the common terminal.
Use an external power
supply to control a dc
load, with the load positive to the positive of the
power supply, the load
negative to the open collector and common to the
power supply negative.
See Quencharc note.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
39
SSR-240-25A-DC1
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Slot A, B
L_
K_
J_
5A at 240V (ac) or
30V (dc) maximum
resistive load
20mA at 24V minimum
load
125VA pilot duty at
120/240V (ac), 25VA
at 24V (ac)
100,000 cycles at rated
load
Output does not supply
power.
For use with ac or dc
L_
normally open
K_
common
J_
normally closed
Output 1: (L1,K1,J1)
PM _ _ _ [E] _ - _ _ _ _
___
Output 3: (L3,K3,J3)
PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ [E] _
___
F_
volts +
G_
current +
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
H_
F3
negative
0 to 10 V
4 to 20 mA
G3
volts +
H3
current +
Output 1: (F1,G1,H1)
PM _ _ _ [F] _ - _ _ _ _
___
Output 3: (F3,G3,H3)
PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ [F] _
___
40
Slot A, B
L_
normally open
K_
common
L_
K_
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Amps RMS
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
-20
-10
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
41
Output 2, 4 Switched DC
Slot A, B
dcdc+
W_
Y_
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Limit Control
Contacts
(If Required)
L2
L1
Heater
Semiconductor
Fuse
1() (+)2
4() (+)3
Switched DC
common
W_
dc -
(-)
SSR-240-25A-DC1
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
(+)
24VDC
Y_
dc +
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
42
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
normally open
common
L_
K_
15A at 85 to 264V
(ac) resistive load only
2,000,000 cycle rating
for NO-ARC circuit
100mA minimum load
2mA maximum off
state leakage
Do not use on dc loads
Output does not supply
power
L_
K_
normally open
common
L_
K_
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
Quencharc Note:
Switching pilot duty inductive
loads (relay coils, solenoids,
etc.) with the mechanical relay,
solid state relay or open collector
output options requires use of an
R.C. suppressor.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
5A at 240V (ac) or
30V (dc) maximum resistive load
20mA at 24V minimum
load
125VA pilot duty @
120/240V (ac), 25VA at
24V (ac)
100,000 cycles at rated
load
Output does not supply
power
For use with ac or dc
L_
K_
43
Warning:
Explosion Hazard Substitution
of component may impair suitability for CLASS I, DIVISION 2.
Warning:
Explosion Hazard - Do not disconnect while the circuit is live
or unless the area is known to be
free of ignitable concentrations
of flammable substances.
0.5A at 20 to 264V
(ac) maximum resistive
load
Slot A, B
normally open
common
L_
L_
K_
K_
Note:
To prevent damage to the controller, do not connect wires to
unused terminals.
Note:
Maintain electrical isolation
between digital input-outputs,
switched dc/open collector
outputs and process outputs to
prevent ground loops.
Note:
This equipment is suitable for
use in CLASS I, DIVISION 2,
Groups A, B, C and D or NonHazardous locations only. Temperature Code T4
Amps RMS
Warning:
Use National Electric (NEC) or
other country-specific standard
wiring and safety practices when
wiring and connecting this controller to a power source and to
electrical sensors or peripheral
devices. Failure to do so may
result in damage to equipment
and property, and/or injury or
loss of life.
Note:
Maximum wire size termination
and torque rating:
0.0507 to 3.30 mm2 (30 to 12
AWG) single-wire termination
or two 1.31 mm2 (16 AWG)
0.56 Nm (5.0 in-lb.) torque
Note:
Adjacent terminals may be labeled differently, depending on
the model number.
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
-20
-10
10
20
30
40
Ambient Temperature ( C)
50
60
70
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
44
User Load
L_
N
Quencharc
K_
98
99
CF common
CD
CE
T-/RT+/R+
B5
D6
D5
Note:
Do not leave a USB to EIA-485 converter connected to Standard Bus without power (i.e.,
disconnecting the USB end from the computer while leaving the converter connected on
Standard Bus). Disturbance on the Standard Bus may occur.
98
99
CC common
CA
CB
B5
D6
D5
T-/RT+/R+
Note:
Do not leave a USB to EIA-485 converter connected to Standard Bus without power (i.e.,
disconnecting the USB end from the computer while leaving the converter connected on
Standard Bus). Disturbance on the Standard Bus may occur.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
45
CB
485 T-/R-
CA
485 common
CC
485 T+/R+
CB
485 T-/R-
CA
232 common
C5
C3
C2
Modbus-IDA
Terminal
DO
EIA/TIA-485
Name
A
Watlow Terminal
Label
CA or CD
D1
CB or CE
T+/R+
common
common
CC or CF
common
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
46
Function
T-/R-
E8
unused
E7
receive -
E6
unused
E5
unused
E4
receive +
E3
transmit -
E2
transmit +
E1
RJ-45 pin
Signal
Slot B, E
brown
unused
E8
unused
E7
green
receive -
E6
unused
E5
blue
unused
E4
receive +
E3
orange
transmit -
E2
transmit +
E1
Network Status
Module Status
Activity Status
Link Status
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
47
Network Status
Indicator State
Summary
Requirement
Steady Off
Not powered,
no IP address
Flashing Green
No connections
Steady Green
Connected
Flashing Red
Connection
timeout
Steady Red
Duplicate IP
Flashing Green
/ Red
Self-test
Module Status
Indicator State
Summary
Steady Off
No power
Steady Green
Device
operational
Flashing
Green
Standby
Flashing Red
Minor fault
Steady Red
Major fault
Flashing
Green / Red
Self-test
Requirement
If no power is supplied to the device, the module status indicator shall be steady off.
If the device is operating correctly, the module status indicator shall be steady green.
If the device has not been configured, the module status indicator shall be flashing green.
If the device has detected a recoverable minor fault, the
module status indicator shall be flashing red.
NOTE: An incorrect or inconsistent configuration would be
considered a minor fault.
If the device has detected a non-recoverable major fault,
the module status indicator shall be steady red.
While the device is performing its power up testing, the
module status indicator shall be flashing green / red.
Activity Status
Indicator State
Summary
Flashing
Green
Detects activity
Red
----
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
Requirement
48
Link Status
Indicator State
Summary
Requirement
Steady Off
Not powered,
unknown link
speed
Green
----
DeviceNet Communications
Slot B, E
V+
Terminal
Signal
Function
V+
V+
DeviceNet power
CAN_H
CH
CH
CAN_H
shield
SH
CAN_L
SH
shield
shield interconnect
CL
CL
CAN_L
V-
V-
V-
V+
V-
T2
S2
R2
Communications instance 2
Slot B (PM [6] _ _ _ _ _ - [5] _ _ _ _ _ _ )
Slot E (PM [4,8,9] _ _ _ _ _ - [5] _ _ _ _ _ _ )
DeviceNet LED Indicators
Viewing the control from the front and then looking on top two LEDs can be seen aligned
vertically front to back. The LED closest to the front is identified as the network (Net) LED
where the one next to it would be identified as the module (Mod) LED.
Network Status
Indicator LED
Off
Green
Red
Flashing
Green
Flashing Red
Description
The device is not online and has not completed the duplicate MAC ID test yet. The device
may not be powered.
The device is online and has connections in
the established state (allcated to a Master).
Failed communication device. The device has
detected an error that has rendered it incapable of communicating on the network (duplicate MAC ID or Bus-off).
The device is online, but no connection has
been allocated or an explicit connection has
timed out.
A poll connection has timed out.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
49
Network Status
Module Status
Module Status
Indicator LED
Off
Flashing Green-Red
Flashing Red
Red
Green
Description
No power is applied to the device.
The device is performing a self-test.
Major Recoverable Fault.
Major Unrecoverable Fault.
The device is operating normally.
Terminal
Signal
Function
CL
CAN_H
CL
CAN_L
CH
Shield
CH
CAN_H
SH
Volts +
SH
shield
shield interconnect
V+
Volts -
V-
V+
V+
V-
V-
Slot B, E
Communications instance 2
Slot B (PM [6] _ _ _ _ _ - [7] _ _ _ _ _ _ )
Slot E (PM [4,8,9] _ _ _ _ _ - [7] _ _ _ _ _ _ )
J1939 LED Indicators
Viewing the control from the rear and then looking on top, two LEDs can be seen aligned
vertically front to back. The LED closest to the front is identified as CAN 2 (channel 2, currently not used) where the one closet to the connector is identified as CAN 1 (channel 1).
CAN 1
Indicator LED
Off
Flashing Red
Flashing
Green
Description
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
50
Profibus DP Communications
Slot B & E
+5Vdc Voltage Potential
485 T+/R+
485 T-/R-
VP
B
A
Digital ground
DG
Termination resistor B
trB
485 T+/R+
485 T-/R-
Termination resistor A
trA
Profibus
Terminal
VP (Voltage
Potential)
B-Line
A-Line
DP-GND
Function
----
VP
+5Vdc
B
A
common
B
A
DG
T+/R+
T-/Rcommon
Description
Profibus network not detected
Indicates that the Profibus card is waiting for
data exchange.
Data exchange mode
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
51
EZ-ZONE ST
ST_ _ - (B or F) _ M _ -_ _ _ _
fuse
EZ-ZONE RM
98
99
CF
CD
B5
CE
D6
D5
-A
+B
power
power
common
98
99
EZ-ZONE PM
power
com
CF
-A
CD
+B
CE
B5
Slot C
D6
CY
CZ
CX
CD
CE
99
CF
98
D5
power
RUI/Gateway
EZKB-_ A _ _- _ _ _ _
98
power
common
CF
-A
CD
+B
99
common
-A
+B
CE
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
52
EZ-ZONE ST
ST_ _ - (B or F) _ M _ -_ _ _ _
EZ-ZONE RM
fuse
98
99
CC
CA
CB
B5
D6
D5
-A
+B
power
power
common
98
99
EZ-ZONE PM
CC
CA
CB
power
power
com
-A
+B
B5
Slot C
D6
CY
CZ
CX
CA
CB
99
CC
98
D5
power
PLC
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P MI C ontrol l er
power
power
common
-A
+B
common
-A
+B
53
Address 1
USB
Port
Slot C
Slot B
Slot A
Slot C
0847-0326-0000
Slot B
Slot A
Data Format
38,400 baud
8 data bits
no parity
1 start bit
1 stop bit
Use twisted pair wires such as Cat 5 cabling. Do not route with power carrying
conductors. Daisy chain wire up to 16 EZ-ZONE devices.
Note:
Do not leave a USB to EIA-485 converter connected to Standard Bus without power (i.e.,
disconnecting the USB end from the computer while leaving the converter connected on
Standard Bus). Disturbance on the Standard Bus may occur.
Note:
When connecting the USB converter to the PC it is suggested that the Latency Timer be
changed from the default of 16 msec to 1 msec. Failure to make this change may cause
communication loss between the PC running EZ-ZONE Configurator software and the control.
To modify Latency Timer settings follow the steps below:
1. Navigate to Device Manager.
2. Double click on Ports.
3. Right click on the USB serial port in
use and select Properties.
4. Click the tab labeled Port settings
and then click the Advance button.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
54
Upper Display:
In the Home Page, displays the
process value, otherwise displays the value of the parameter in the lower display.
Zone Display:
Indicates the controller zone.
1 to q = zones 1 to 9
A = zone 10 E = zone 14
b = zone 11 F = zone 15
C = zone 12 h = zone 16
d = zone 13
Lower Display:
Indicates the set point or
Manual Power value during
operation, or the parameter
whose value appears in the
upper display.
Temperature Units:
Indicates whether the
temperature is displayed in
Fahrenheit or Celsius.
Percent Units:
Lights when the controller is displaying values as
a percentage or when the
Manual Power is displayed.
Output Activity:
Number LEDs indicate
activity of outputs. A flashing light indicates output
activity.
Profile Activity:
Lights when a profile is
running. Flashes when a
profile is paused.
EZ Key/s:
This key can be programmed
to do various tasks, such as
starting a profile.
Channel Display:
Indicates the channel for any
given EZ-ZONE module.
- Available with the PM4, 8 and
9 only.
Communications Activity
Flashes when another
device is communicating
with this controller.
Advance Key
Advances through parameter prompts.
Note:
Upon power up, the upper
or left display will briefly
indicate the firmware revision and the lower or right
display will show PM representing the model.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E P M Integrated Contr olle r 55
Cha pte r 3 Ke y s a nd Di s p l a y s
Display
attn
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Attention
An active message will cause the display
to toggle between the normal settings and
the active message in the upper display
and attn in the lower display. Your response will depend on the message and
the controller settings. Some messages,
such as Ramping and Tuning, indicate that
a process is underway. If the message was
generated by a latched alarm or limit condition, the message can be cleared when
the condition no longer exists. If an alarm
has silencing enabled, it can be silenced.
1. Push the Advance Key to display
ignr in the upper display and the message source (such as AL.h1) in the lower
display.
Appears If
An alarm or error
message is active.
Alarm Error 1 to 4
Er.i1 Er.i2 Error Input 1 or 2
Li.L1 Limit Low 1
Li.h1 Limit High 1
Li.E1 Limit Error 1
tUn1 tUn2 Tuning 1 or 2
rp1 rp2 Ramping 1 or 2
Lp.o1 Lp.o2 Loop Open Error
1 or 2
Lp.r1 Lp.r2 Loop Reversed Error 1 or 2
Note:
If the limit is tripped and the trip condi- C.Er1 Current Error
tion is no longer present the limit can be h.Er1 Heater Error
reset by pressing the Reset Key (Infin- vaL.h Value to high to be displayed in 4 digit LED display
ity Key is labeled Reset).
>9999
2. Use the Up and Down keys to
vaL.L Value to low to be disscroll through possible responses, such
played in 4 digit LED display
as Clear CLr or Silence SiL.
<-1999
RESET
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E P MI C ontrol l er
56
Cha pte r 3 Ke y s a nd Di s p l a y s
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
57
[``Ai]
[``70]
[`Set]
[``72]
Home Page from anywhere: Press the Infinity Key for two seconds to return to the Home Page.
[``70]
[``Ai]
[``72]
[oper]
Operations Page from Home Page: Press both the Up and Down keys for three seconds.
[``70]
[``Ai]
[``72]
[`Set]
Note:
Keys must be held continuously
until sEt is displayed in green. If
keys are released when opEr is displayed, press the infinity key or reset key to exit and repeat until sEt
is displayed.
Setup Page from Home Page: Press both the Up and Down keys for six seconds.
[``70]
[``p1]
[``72]
[prof]
Profiling Page from Home Page: Press the Advance Key for three seconds
[``70]
[Cust]
[``72]
[fCty]
Factory Page from Home Page: Press both the Advance and Infinity keys for six seconds.
58
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
Blank
ain1
i.Ca1
C_f1
Usr.1
a.Lo1
a.hi1
a.hy1
59
ain2
i.Ca2
Usr.2
A.Lo2 a.Lo3 A.Lo4
a.hi2 a.hi3 a.hi4
a.hy2 a.hy3 a.hy4
t.r
r.bS
rdy
Ct.Sp
hoUr
in
SEC
LL.s1
Lh.s1
L.hy1
L.st1
C.sp1 C.sp2
AC.p1 AC.p2
AC.s1 AC.s2
o.sp1 o.sp2
aUt1 aUt2
C.1 C.2
h.pr1 h.pr2
C.pr1 C.pr2
ti1 ti2
td1 td2
db1 db2
h.pb1 h.pb2
h.hy1 h.hy2
C.pb1 C.pb2
C.hy1 C.hy2
r.rt1 r.rt2
t.tU1 t.tU2
id.s1 id.s2
p.str
p.aCr
Stp
S.typ
60
t.sp1, t.sp2
HoUr
in
sEC
gsd1
Hour
Minute
Second
Guaranteed Soak Deviation 1
CU.r1
* The numerical digit shown in the prompts above (last digit), represents the parameter
instance and can be greater than one.
Modifying the Display Pairs
The Home Page, being a customized list of as many as 20 parameters, can be configured in
pairs of up to 10 via the Display Pairs d.prs prompt found in the Global Menu gLbL (Setup
Page). The listing in the table that follows is what one may typically find in the Home Page
as defaults based on controller part numbers. It is important to note that some of the
prompts shown may not appear simply because the feature is not being used or is turned off.
As an example, the prompt shown in position 7 (loop 1) and position 12 (loop 2) C.pr will not
appear unless the Cool algorithm C.ag is turned on in the Setup Page under the Loop menu.
If the ninth digit of the part number is C, J, L or M (PM _ _ _ _ _ - _ [C, J, L, M] _ _ _ _ _)
the Display Pairs d.prs prompt will default to 2; otherwise, it will be equal to one.
As stated above, the user can define pairs of prompts to appear on the display every time
the Advance key is pushed. The first pair will always be as defined in the Custom Menu
and as stated, will default (factory settings) to the Active Process Value loop 1 aC.pu, and
the Active Set Point loop 1 aC.sp. If two channels are present the first 2 pairs will be the
same in that the first pair will represent channel 1 Active Process Value and Active Set Point
and the second being the same for channel 2. If another pair is created where the Display
Pairs d.prs prompt is equal to 3 using the default prompts, when the Advance Key is
pushed two times from the Home Page the upper display will reflect the current control
mode and the bottom display would show the output power. When configuring the Custom
Menu to your liking it should be noted that if a writable value is placed on the upper display
and is paired with another read only parameter on the lower display, the arrow keys will affect the setting of the upper display. Also, if 2 changeable (writable) prompts are displayed
in a Pair, i.e., Control Mode on top and Idle Set Point on the bottom, only the lower display
(Idle Set Point) can be changed.
The display can be configured to scroll customized pairs by going to the Setup Page under
the Global Menu and changing the Display Time d.ti prompt to something greater than 0 and
by changing the Display Pairs d.prs to something greater than 1. If the Display Time d.ti is
set to 2, the display will toggle every 2 seconds from the first display pair to the second and
then the third, etc... If the control has more than one channel and one of the configured
pairs is set as instance 2, the channel indicator (LED) will change from 1 to 2 reflecting the
channel of the pair being displayed. The display will continue to toggle through all of the
custom pairs at the specified time interval.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
61
Possible
Home Page Defaults
(Dependent on Part Number)
Home
Page
Display
All Models
1
Numerical
value
Numerical
value
Numerical
value
Numerical
value
Limit Status
Numerical
value
safE
or
Home Page
faiL
If 4th digit of part number is equal to: PM _ [T] _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ _ _
4
Numerical
value
pu.a2
C.sp2
C.1
Hours (1)
Minutes (1)
10
Seconds (2)
r.bs
rdy
Ct.SP
hoUr
in
SEC
Autotune (1)
10
11
12
h.pr1
C.pr1
aUt1
id.s1
C.2
h.pr2
C.pr2
62
Possible
Home Page Defaults
(Dependent on Part Number)
13
Autotune (2)
14
15
17
Profile Start
18
Action Request
19
None
20
None
Home
Page
Display
aUt2
id.s2
LL.s1
p.st1
p.aC1
Note:
The numerical digit shown in the prompts (last digit) and within the parenthesize above,
represents the parameter instance and can be greater than one.
Parameter Name
Range
Defines options available for this prompt, i.e., min/max values (numerical), yes/no,
etc... (further explanation below).
Default
Identifies unique parameters using either the Modbus RTU or Modbus TCP protocols
(further explanation below).
Profibus Index
Parameter ID
Identifies unique parameters used with other software such as, LabVIEW.
uint
dint
string
float
RWES
=
=
=
=
=
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
63
Display
Visual information from the control is displayed to the observer using a fairly standard 7
segment display. Due to the use of this technology, several characters displayed need some
interpretation, see the list below:
1=1
2=2
3=3
4=4
5=5
=7
8=8
q=9
0=0
=A
, { = c
=d
E=E
F=F
g=g
i=i
J=J
H=K
L=L
= M
o
P
q
r
S
=o
6=6
b=b
h=h
n=n
t=t
=P
=q
=r
=S
u, U = u
u, U = v
= W
y=y
Z=Z
Range
Within this column notice that on occasion there will be numbers found within parenthesis.
This number represents the enumerated value for that particular selection. Range selections
can be made simply by writing the enumerated value of choice using any of the available
communications protocols. As an example, turn to the Setup Page and look at the Analog
Input Ai menu and then the Sensor Type sEn prompt. To turn the sensor off using Modbus
simply write the value of 62 (off) to register 368 and send that value to the control.
Communication Protocols
When using a communications protocol in conjunction with the EZ-ZONE PM there are two
possible ports (instances) used. Port 1 or instance 1 is always dedicated to Standard Bus communications. This same instance can also be used for Modbus RTU if ordered. Depending on
the controller part number, port 2 (instance 2) can be used with Modbus, CIP, J1939 CAN and
Profibus. For further information read through the remainder of this section.
Note:
With the release of firmware revision 7.00 and above new functions where introduced into
this product line. With the introduction of these new functions there was a reorganization
of Modbus registers. Notice in the column identified as Modbus the reference to Map 1 and
Map 2 registers for each of the various parameters. If the new functions, namely; Math,
Linearization, Process Value, Real Time Clock and the Special Output Function are to be
used than use Map 2 Modbus registers. If the new functions of this product line are not to
be used, Map 1 (legacy PM controls) Modbus registers will be sufficient. The Modbus register mapping [map] can be changed in the Setup Page under the Co Menu. This setting
will apply across the control. We recommend to use Map 2 for all new applications. Use
Map 1 only if desired to maintain backwards compatibility.
It should also be noted that some of the cells in the Modbus column contain wording pertaining to an offset. Several parameters in the control contain more than one instance; such
as, profiles (4), alarms (4), analog inputs (2), etc... The Modbus register shown always represents instance one. Take for an example the Silence Alarm parameter found in the Setup
Page under the Alarm Menu. Instance one of Map 1 is shown as address 1490 and +50 is identified as the offset to the next instance. If there was a desire to read or write to instance
3 simply add 100 to 1490 to find its address, in this case, the instance 3 address for Silence
Alarm is 1590.
The Modbus communications instance can be either 1 or 2 depending on the part number.
Instance 1:
PM _ _ _ _ _ - [1] _ _ _ _ _ _
Instance 2:
PM _ _ _ _ _ - [2] _ _ _ _ _ _
To learn more about the Modbus protocol point your browser to http://www.modbus.org.
J1939 CAN
This protocol was originally introduced back in the 80s by Robert Bosch and was quickly adopted and incorporated into many new cars. Because of its reliability and wide acceptance,
this protocol is also used heavily within heavy-duty vehicles, e.g., trucks, buses, etc... The
J1939 communications will always be instance 2 as implemented in the EZ-ZONE PM.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
65
To learn more about the Controller Area Network protocol, click on the link that follows:
http://www.can-cia.org/
Profibus DP
To accommodate for Profibus DP addressing the following menus contain a column identified
as Profibus Index. Data types used in conjunction with Profibus DP can be found in the table
below.
The Profibus communications instance will always be instance 2.
real
= Float, IEEE 754 32-bit
int
= Signed 16-bit integer
byte
= 8-bits
To learn more about the Profibus DP protocol point your browser to http://www.profibus.org
66
Ai
opEr
Lnr
Analog Input Menu
1
Ai Analog Input (1 to 2)
Ain Analog Input Value
i.Er Input Error
i.CA Calibration Offset
1
Lnr Linearization (1 to 2)
Su.a Source Value A
ofst Offset
o.u Output Value
d.bi
Pu
opEr
1
d.bi J1939 Instance (1 to 6)
vALU Input Value
i.Er Input Error
o.u Output Value
Err Output Error
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
67
dio
aL
1
dio Digital Input/Output (5 to 12)
do.S Output State
di.S Input State
Ei.s Event Status
1
aL Alarm (1 to 4)
A.Lo Low Set Point
a.hi High Set Point
a.CLr Clear Alarm
a.Sir Silence Alarm
a.st Alarm State
Li
opEr Limit Menu
1
Li Limit
LL.S Low Limit Set Point
Lh.S High Limit Set Point
LCr Clear Limit
L.St Limit Status
on
opEr Monitor Menu
1
on Monitor (1 to 2)
C.A Control Mode Active
h.pr Heat Power
C.pr Cool Power
C.sp Closed-Loop Set Point
pu.a Process Value Active
Loop
opEr Loop Menu
1
Loop Loop (1 to 2)
r.En Remote Set Point
C. Control Mode
A.tsp Autotune Set Point
aUt Autotune
C.sp Closed Loop Set Point
id.S Idle Set Point
h.pb Heat Proportional Band
h.hy On/Off Heat Hysteresis
C.pb Cool Proportional Band
C.hy On/Off Cool Hysteresis
ti
Time Integral
td
Time Derivative
db Dead Band
o.sp Manual Power
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
CUrr
opEr Current Menu
C.hi High Set Point
C.Lo Low Set Point
Ld.Cu Load Current RMS
C.Er Error
h.Er Heater Error
tr
oPEr Timer Menu
Su.A Source Value A
Su.C Source Value C
Su.d Source Value D
P.PS1 Produced Set Point 1
tE.o1 Timer Event Output 1
tE.o2 Timer Event Output 2
tE.o3 Timer Event Output 3
t.r Time Remaining
r.bS Ready Band State
hoUr Hours
in Minutes
SEC Seconds
Ct.SP Closed Loop Timer Set Point
at
opEr Math Menu
Su.a Source Value A
Su.b Source Value B
Su.E Source Value E
ofst Offset
o.u Output Value
sof
opEr Special Output Function Menu
Su.a Source Value A
Su.b Source Value B
ou.1 Output Value 1
ou.2 Output Value 2
68
P.sta
opEr
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
69
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Ai
opEr
Analog Input Menu
Ain
Ain
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Analog Input Value
View the process
value.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
4001
float
R
4002
uint
R
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Calibration Offset
Offset the input
reading to compensate for lead wire
resistance or other
factors that cause
the input reading to
vary from the actual process value.
4012
float
RWES
Note:
Ensure that the
Input Error (below)
indicates no error
(61) when reading
this value using a
field bus protocol.
If an error exists,
the last known
value prior to the
error occurring will
be returned.
i.Er
i.Er
i.Ca
i.CA
-1,999.000 to
0.0
9,999.000F or units
-1,110.555 to
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
442
452
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
462
472
70
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
d.bi
opEr
Digital Bus Menu (J1939 CAN)
d.bi
d.bi
vaLU
vaLU
i.Er
i.Er
o.u
o.u
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
J1939 Instance
Select the desired
instance.
1 to 6
----
----
----
- - - - - - - - float
RW
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Input Value
View the input
value.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
----
----
----
- - - - 95001 float
RW
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Input Error
Selected sensor
instance is in error
state.
Stale
nonE None (61)
OpEn Open (65)
shrt Shorted (127)
E. Measurement
----
----
- - - - 95002 float
RW
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Output Value
View the output
value.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
----
----
- - - - 95003 float
R
Error (140)
E.CaL Bad Calibration Data (139)
Er.ab Ambient Error (9)
E.rtd RTD Error
(141)
faiL Fail (32)
Er.. Math Error
(1423)
nsrc Not Sourced
(246)
StAL Stale (883)
----
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
71
Operations Page
Display
Err
Err
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Output Error
Range
Default
Stale
nonE None (61)
OpEn Open (65)
shrt Shorted (127)
E. Measurement
Modbus
Relative Address
----
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
----
Data
Type
and
Access
**
- - - - 95004 float
R
Error (140)
E.CaL Bad Calibration Data (139)
Er.ab Ambient Error (9)
E.rtd RTD Error
(141)
faiL Fail (32)
Er.. Math Error
(1423)
nsrc Not Sourced
(246)
StAL Stale (883)
Lnr
opEr
Linearization Menu
Su.a
Su.A
ofst
oFSt
Linearization (1 to
2)
Source Value A
View the value of
Source A.
Source A of Linearization 1 is connected to Analog
Input 1, Source A of
Linearization 2 is
connected to Analog
Input 2
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x86
Map 1 Map 2 (134)
- - - - 3566 1 to 2
Instance 2 4
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3636
- - - - 34004 float
R
Linearization (1 to
2)
Offset
Set an offset to
be applied to this
function's output.
-1,999.000 to
0
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x86
Map 1 Map 2 (134)
- - - - 3570 1 to 2
Instance 2 6
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3640
- - - - 34006 float
RWES
72
Operations Page
Display
o.u
o.v
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Value
View the value of
this function's output.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x86
Map 1 Map 2 (134)
- - - - 3572 1 to 2
Instance 2 7
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3642
- - - - 34007 float
R
Linearization (1 to
2)
Error
View reported
cause for Linearization output malfunction.
None (61)
---Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement error
(140)
Bad calibration data
(139)
Ambient error (9)
RTD error (14)
Fail (32)
Math error (1423)
Not sourced (246)
Stale (1617)
Can't process (1659)
Instance 1 0x86
Map 1 Map 2 (134)
- - - - 3614 1 to 2
Instance 2 0x1C (28)
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3684
- - - - 34028 uint
R
Process Value (1 to
2)
Source Value A
View the value of
Source A.
Linearization 1 is
connected to Source
A of Process Value 1
Linearization 2 is
connected to Source
A of Process Value 2
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Process Value (1 to
2)
Source Value B
View the value of
Source B.
Linearization 2 is
connected to Source
B of Process Value 1
Linearization 1 is
connected to Source
B of Process Value 2
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Pu
opEr
Process Value Menu
Su.a
Su.A
Su.b
Su.b
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3380
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3382
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
73
Operations Page
Display
ofst
oFSt
o.u
o.u
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Process Value (1 to
2)
Offset
Set an offset to
be applied to this
function's output.
-1,999.000 to
0
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Process Value (1 to
2)
Output Value
View the value of
this function block's
output.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Process Value (1 to
2)
Output Error
View reported
cause for Process
output malfunction.
None (61)
---Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement error
(140)
Bad calibration data
(139)
Ambient error (9)
RTD error (14)
Fail (32)
Math error (1423)
Not sourced (246)
Stale (1617)
Can't process (1659)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3332
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3402
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3394
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3392
0x7E
- - - - 26027 uint
(126)
R
(134)
1 to 2
0x1B (27)
dio
opEr
Digital Input/Output Menu
do.s
do.S
di.s
di.S
Digital Output (5 to
12)
Output State
View the state of
this output.
----
6007
uint
R
Digital Input (5 to
12)
Input State
View this event input state.
----
uint
R
46
74
Operations Page
Display
Ei.s
Ei.S
Ei.s
Ei.S
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Digital Input (5 to 6)
Event Status
View this event input state.
Digital Input (7 to
12)
Event Status
View this event input state.
----
EZ-Key/s (1 to 2)
Event Status
View this event input state.
----
----
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
140
10005 uint
R
140
10005 uint
R
140
10005 uint
R
Offset to
next instance
equals +20
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1348 1588
Li
opEr
Limit Menu
Limit (1)
Low Limit Set Point
Set the low process
value that will trigger the limit.
-1,999.000 to
0.0F or Instance 1 0x70 (112)
9,999.000F or units units
Map 1 Map 2 1
-1,128.000 to
-18.0C 684
724 3
5,537.000C
38
12003 float
RWES
Limit (1)
High Limit Set
Point
Set the high process
value that will trigger the limit.
-1,999.000 to
0.0F or Instance 1 0x70 (112)
9,999.000F or units units
Map 1 Map 2 1
-1,128.000 to
-18.0C 686
726 4
5,537.000C
39
12004 float
RWES
No Display
Limit (1)
Limit State
Clear limit once
limit condition is
cleared.
Off (62)
None (61)
Limit High (51)
Limit Low (52)
Error (225)
----
LCr
Limit (1)
Clear Limit *
Clear limit once
limit condition is
cleared.
Clear (0)
No Change (255)
----
LL.s
LL.S
Lh.s
Lh.S
LCr
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
75
Operations Page
Display
L.st
L.St
Parameter Name
Description
Limit (1)
Limit Status *
Reflects whether
or not the limit is
in a safe or failed
mode..
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
----
Monitor (1 to 2)
Control Mode Active
View the current
control mode.
----
Monitor (1 to 2)
Heat Power
View the current
heat output level.
0.0 to 100.0%
----
Monitor (1 to 2)
Cool Power
View the current
cool output level.
-100.0 to 0.0%
Monitor (1 to 2)
Closed-Loop Set
Point
View the working set
point currently in effect.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Monitor (1 to 2)
Process Value Active
View the current filtered process value
using the control
input.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
on
opEr
Monitor Menu
C.A
C.MA
h.pr
h.Pr
C.pr
C.Pr
C.sp
C.SP
pu.a
Pv.A
uint
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1952 2432
Instance 1 0x97 (151) - - - - 8011
Map 1 Map 2 1 to 2
1904
2384 0xD (13)
float
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1974 2454
----
float
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1976 2456
----
----
----
- - - - 8029
float
R
float
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
482 492
76
Operations Page
Display
No Display
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Monitor (1 to 2)
-1,999.000 to
Set Point Active
9,999.000F or
Read the current ac- units
tive set point.
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Monitor (1 to 2)
Autotune Status
Read the present
status of Autotune.
Default
----
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
8031 float
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2252 2732
Off (62)
---Waiting for cross 1
positive (119)
Waiting for cross 1
negative (120)
Waiting for cross 2
positive (121)
Waiting for cross 2
negative (122)
Waiting for cross 3
positive (123)
Waiting for cross 3
negative (150)
Measuring maximum
peak (151)
Measuring minimum
peak (152)
Calculating (153)
Complete (18)
Timeout (118)
uint
R
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2002 2482
Loop
opEr
Control Loop Menu
r.En
r.En
C.
C.M
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Remote Set Point
Enable this loop
to switch control
to the remote set
point.
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Control Mode
Select the method
that this loop will
use to control.
No
Instance 1 0x6B
Map 1 Map 2 (107)
2200 2680 1 to 2
Instance 2 0x15 (21)
48
7021
uint
RWES
Instance 1 0x97
Map 1 Map 2 (151)
1880 2360 1 to 2
Instance 2 1
63
8001
uint
RWES
Map 1 Map 2
2280 2760
Auto
Map 1 Map 2
1950 2430
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
77
Operations Page
Display
a.tsp
A.tSP
AUt
AUt
C.sp
C.SP
id.s
id.S
h.pb
h.Pb
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Control Loop (1 to
50.0 to 200.0%
2)
Autotune Set Point
Set the set point
that the autotune
will use, as a percentage of the current set point.
90.0
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Autotune
Start an autotune.
While the autotune
is active, the
Home Page will
display attn
tUn1. When the
autotune is complete, the message
will clear automatically.
No
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Instance 1 0x97
Map 1 Map 2 (151)
1918 2398 1 to 2
Instance 2 0x14 (20)
- - - - 8025
Data
Type
and
Access
**
float
RWES
Map 1 Map 2
1988 2468
Instance 1 0x97
Map 1 Map 2 (151)
1920 2400 1 to 2
Instance 2 0x15 (21)
64
8026
uint
RW
Map 1 Map 2
1990 2470
Control Loop (1 to
Low Set Point to
2)
Maximum Set Point
Set Point
(Setup Page)
Set the closed loop
set point that the
controller will automatically control
to.
75.0F
Instance 1 0x6B
or units Map 1 Map 2 (107)
24.0C 2160 2640 1 to 2
Instance 2 1
49
7001
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Idle Set Point
Define a set point
that can be triggered by an event
state.
75.0F
Instance 1 0x6B
or units Map 1 Map 2 (107)
24.0C 2176 2656 1 to 2
Instance 2 9
50
7009
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Heat Proportional
Band
Set the PID proportional band for the
heat outputs.
0.001 to
25.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
0.001 to
14.0C 1890 2370
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1960 2440
65
8009
float
RWES
Map 1 Map 2
2240 2720
Map 1 Map 2
2197 2736
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
6
78
Operations Page
Display
h.hy
h.hy
C.pb
C.Pb
C.hy
C.hy
ti
ti
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Control Loop (1 to
2)
On/Off Heat Hysteresis
Set the control
switching hysteresis for on-off control. This determines how far into
the on region
the process value
needs to move
before the output
turns on.
0.001 to
3.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
0.001 to
2.0C
1900 2380
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1970 2450
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0xB (11)
66
8010
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Cool Proportional
Band
Set the PID proportional band for the
cool outputs.
0.001 to
25.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
0.001 to
14.0C 1892 2372
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1962 2442
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
7
67
8012
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
On/Off Cool Hysteresis
Set the control
switching hysteresis for on-off control. This determines how far into
the on region
the process value
needs to move
before the output
turns on.
0.001 to
3.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
0.001 to
2.0C
1902 2382
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1972 2522
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0xC (12)
68
8013
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Time Integral
Set the PID integral for the outputs.
0 to 9,999 seconds
per repeat
69
8006
float
RWES
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
79
Operations Page
Display
td
td
db
db
o.sp
o.SP
No Display
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Time Derivative
Set the PID derivative time for the
outputs.
Range
0 to 9,999 seconds
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
0
Instance 1 0x97
seconds Map 1 Map 2 (151)
1896 2376 1 to 2
Instance 2 9
Data
Type
and
Access
**
70
8007
float
RWES
Instance 1 0x97
Map 1 Map 2 (151)
1898 2378 1 to 2
Instance 2 0xA (10)
71
8008
float
RWES
Instance 1 0x6B
Map 1 Map 2 (107)
2162 2642 1 to 2
Instance 2 2
51
7002
float
RWES
Map 1 Map 2
1966 2446
Control Loop (1 to
-1,000.0 to
2)
1,000.0F or units
Dead Band
-556 to 556C
Set the offset to
the proportional
band. With a negative value, both
heating and cooling outputs are
active when the
process value is
near the set point.
A positive value
keeps heating and
cooling outputs
from fighting each
other.
0.0
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Manual Power
Set a fixed level
of output power
when in manual
(open-loop) mode.
0.0
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Loop Error
Open Loop detect
deviation has been
exceeded.
----
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Clear Loop Error
Current state of
limit output.
Map 1 Map 2
1968 2448
Map 1 Map 2
2242 2722
(1274)
Lp.r Reversed Sensor (1275)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1928 2408
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1998 2478
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1930 2410
0x6C
- - 8048 uint
R
(108)
-1
0x30 (48)
0x6C (108) - - - 1
0x31 (49)
8049
uint
W
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2000 2480
80
Operations Page
Display
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Loop Output Power
View the loop output power.
Range
-100.0 to 100.0
Default
----
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
8033
float
R
9002
float
RWES
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1978 2458
aL
opEr
Alarm Menu
a.Lo
A.Lo
Alarm (1 to 4)
Low Set Point
If Type (Setup
Page, Alarm Menu)
is set to:
Process - set the
process value that
will trigger a low
alarm.
-1,999.000 to
32.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
-1,128.000 to
0.0C
1482 1882
5,537.000C
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1)
equals +50
0x6D
(109)
1 to 24
2
18
Offset to
next instance
(Map 2)
equals +60
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
81
Operations Page
Display
a.hi
A.hi
Parameter Name
Description
Alarm (1 to 4)
High Set Point
If Type (Setup
Page, Alarm Menu)
is set to:
Range
Default
-1,999.000 to
300.0
9,999.000F or units F or
-1,128.000 to
units
5,537.000C
150.0
C
A.CLr
A.sir
A.Sir
Instance 1 0x6D
Map 1 Map 2 (109)
1480 1880 1 to 4
1
Offset to
19
9001
Data
Type
and
Access
**
float
RWES
next instance
(Map 1)
equals +50
Offset to
next instance
(Map 2)
equals +60
A.CLr
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Alarm (1 to 4)
Clear Alarm
Write to this register to clear an
alarm
Alarm (1 to 4)
Silence Alarm
Write to this register to silence an
alarm
----
Instance 1 0x6D
Map 1 Map 2 (109)
1504 1904 1 to 4
0x0D (13)
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
- - - - 9026
uint
W
Instance 1 0x6D
Map 1 Map 2 (109)
1506 1906 1 to 4
0x0E (14)
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
- - - - 9027
uint
W
82
Operations Page
Display
A.st
A.St
No Display
No Display
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Alarm (1 to 4)
State
Current state of
alarm
Alarm (1 to 4)
Alarm Clearable
Indicates if alarm
can be cleared.
Range
Startup (88)
None (61)
Blocked (12)
Alarm low (8)
Alarm high (7)
Error (28)
Default
----
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Instance 1 0x6D
Map 1 Map 2 (109)
1496 1896 1 to 2
9
Offset to
- - - - 9009
uint
R
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1502 1902
----
9012
uint
R
0x6D
---(109)
1 to 4
0x0B (11)
9011
uint
R
0x6D
---(109)
1 to 4
0x0A (10)
9010
uint
R
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
No (59)
Yes (106)
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
Alarm (1 to 4)
No (59)
Alarm Silenced
Yes (106)
Indicates if alarm is
silenced.
----
Alarm (1 to 4)
No (59)
Alarm Latched
Yes (106)
Indicates if alarm is
latched.
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1500 1900
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1498 1898
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals +50,
Map 2 equals
+60)
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0xC (12)
CUrr
opEr
Current Menu
C.hi
C.hi
Current (1)
High Set Point
Set the current value that will trigger
a high heater error
state.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
50.0
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1134 1374 1
8
- - - - 15008 float
RWES
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
83
Operations Page
Display
C.Lo
C.Lo
Ld.Cu
CU.r
C.Er
C.Er
h.Er
h.Er
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Current (1)
-1,999.000 to
Low Set Point
9,999.000
Set the current
value that will
trigger a low heater error state.
0.0
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1136 1376 1
9
- - - - 15009 float
RWES
Current (1)
Load Current RMS
View the RMS
value of the measured current.
0 to 9,999.00
----
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1132 1372 1
7
- - - - 15007 float
R
Current (1)
Error
View the most recent load fault.
----
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1160 1400 1
2
- - - - 15002 uint
R
Current (1)
Heater Error
Determine if load
current flow is
within the High and
Low Set Points.
----
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1124 1364 1
3
- - - - 15003 uint
R
Current (1)
Error Status
View the most recent load fault
None (61)
Fail (32
----
Instance 1 0x73
Map 1 Map 2 (115)
1160 1400 1
21
- - - - 15021 uint
R
- - - - 31007 uint
R
(127)
tr
oPEr
Timer Menu
Su.A
Su.A
Su.C
Su.C
Su.d
Su.d
P.SP1
P.SP1
Timer (1)
Source Value A
View the state of
Source Function A.
on On (63)
oFF Off (62)
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4582 8012
0x83
(109)
1
0x07 (7)
Timer (1)
Source Value C
View the value of
Source Function C.
-1999.000 to
999.000F or units
-1110.555 to
5555.000
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4642 8572
0x83
- - - - 31037 float
(109)
R
1
0x25 (37)
Timer (1)
Source Value D
View the state of
Source Function D.
on On (63)
oFF Off (62)
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4644 8574
0x83
- - - - 31038 uint
(109)
R
1
0x26 (38)
Timer (1)
Produced Set Point
1
View the value of
Set Point 1.
-1999.000 to
999.000F or units
-1110.555 to
5555.000
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4646 8576
0x83
- - - - 31039 float
(109)
R
1
0x27 (39)
84
Operations Page
Display
tE.o1
tE.o1
tE.o2
tE.o2
tE.o3
tE.o3
t.r
t.r
r.bS
r.bS
hoUr
hoUr
in
Min
SEC
SEC
Ct.SP
Ct.SP
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Timer (1)
Timer Event Output 1
View the state of
Event Output 1.
on On (63)
oFF Off (62)
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4648 8578
0x83
- - - - 31040 uint
(109)
R
1
0x28 (40)
Timer (1)
Timer Event Output 2
View the state of
Event Output 2.
on On (63)
oFF Off (62)
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4650 8580
0x83
- - - - 31041 uint
(109)
R
1
0x29 (41)
Timer (1)
Timer Event Output 3
View the state of
Event Output 3.
on On (63)
oFF Off (62)
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4662 8590
0x83
- - - - 31046 uint
(109)
R
1
0x2E (46)
Timer (1)
Time Remaining
Display the time
remaining on the
timer.
00.00 00:00 to
Timer (1)
Ready Band State
Display whether the
process value is in
the ready band.
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31021 string
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
0x15
(21)
- - - - - - - -
99:59
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31022 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
4612 8542 0x16 (22)
Timer (1)
0 to 99
Hours
Set the timer period
hours.
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31025 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
RWES
0x19
(25)
4618 8548
Timer (1)
0 to 59
Minutes
Set the timer period
minutes.
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31026 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
RWES
0x1A
(26)
4620 8550
Timer (1)
0 to 59
Seconds
Set the timer period
seconds.
10
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31027 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
RWES
4622 8552 0x1B (27)
-1999.000 to
75
9999.000F or units
-1110.555 to
5555.000C
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31028 float
1
Map 1 Map 2
RWES
0x1C
(28)
4624 8554
Timer (1)
Closed Loop Timer
Set Point
Set the set point
that will be in effect during the
timer period.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
85
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
No Display
Timer (1)
On (63)
Timer Timing
Off (62)
Indicates whether
the timer is running.
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31015 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
0x0F
(15)
4598 8528
No Display
Timer (1)
Output Error
Indicates errors that
may have interfered
with the timer operation.
None (61)
Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement Error
(140)
Bad Calibration Data
(139)
Ambient Error (9)
RTD Error (141)
Fail (32)
Math Error (1423)
Not Sourced (246
Stale (1617)
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31018 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
4604 8534 0x12 (18)
No Display
Timer (1)
Indicator Request
View the status of
the timer illuminated indicators.
Off (62)
Ready (1662)
Ready Ack (1950)
Running (149)
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31042 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
4652 8582 0x2A (42)
No Display
Timer (1)
Countdown State
View the state of
the countdown
cycle.
Inactive (41)
Wait Process (209)
Wait Event (144)
Running (149)
Pause (146)
Complete (18)
End (27)
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31043 uint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
0x2B
(43)
4654 8584
No Display
Timer (1)
0 to 4,294,967,295
Elapsed Signal Time mS
Counts from 0 to
Signal Time while
signal time is active.
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31047 udint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
0x2F
(47)
4662 8592
No Display
Timer (1)
Elapsed Time
Counts from 0 to
Countdown Time
while time cycle is
active.
----
Instance 1
0x83 (131) - - - - 31048 udint
1
Map 1 Map 2
R
0x30
(48)
4664 8594
0 to 4,294,967,295
mS
86
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
at
opEr
Math Menu
Su.a
Su.A
Su.b
Su.b
Su.E
Su.E
ofst
oFSt
o.u
o.v
No Display
Math (1)
Source Value A
View the value of
Source A.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3030 1
0x10 (16)
- - - - 25016 float
R
Math (1)
Source Value B
View the value of
Source B.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3032 1
0x11 (17)
- - - - 25017 float
R
Math (1)
Source Value E
View the value of
Source E.
----
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3038 1
0x14 (20)
- - - - 25020 uint
R
Math (1)
Offset
Set an offset to
be applied to this
function's output.
-1,999.000 to
0
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3044 1
0x17 (23)
- - - - 25023 float
RWES
Math (1)
Output Value
View the value of
this function's output.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3042 1
0x16 (22)
- - - - 25022 float
R
Math (1)
Error
Read reported
cause for math error
None (61)
Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement Error
(140)
Bad Cal Data (139)
Ambient Error (9)
RTD Error (141)
Fail (32)
Math Error (1423)
Not Sourced (246)
Stale (1617)
Instance 1 0x7D
Map 1 Map 2 (125)
- - - - 3056 1
0x1D (29)
- - - - 25029 uint
R
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3852 1
7
- - - - 35007 float
R
----
Sof
opEr
Special Output Function Menu
Su.a
Su.A
Special Output
Function (1)
Source Value A
View the value of
Source A.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
87
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Special Output
Function (1)
Source Value B
View the value of
Source B.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3854 1
8
- - - - 35008 float
R
Special Output
Function (1)
Output Value 1
View the value of
this function's Output 1.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3858 1
0xA (10)
- - - - 35010 float
R
Special Output
Function (1)
Output Value 2
View the value of
this function's Output 2.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3862 1
0xC (12)
- - - - 35012 float
R
No Display
Special Output
Function (1)
Error 1
View reported output malfunction.
None (61)
---Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement error
(140)
Bad calibration data
(139)
Ambient error (9)
RTD error (14)
Fail (32)
Math error (1423)
Not sourced (246)
Stale (1617)
Can't process (1659)
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3860 1
0x0B (11)
- - - - 35011 uint
R
No Display
Special Output
Function (1 to 4)
Error 2
View reported cause
for output malfunction.
None (61)
---Open (65)
Shorted (127)
Measurement error
(140)
Bad calibration data
(139)
Ambient error (9)
RTD error (14)
Fail (32)
Math error (1423)
Not sourced (246)
Stale (1617)
Can't process (1659)
Instance 1 0x87
Map 1 Map 2 (135)
- - - - 3940 1 to 4
0x0D (13)
- - - - 35013 uint
R
Su.b
Su.b
o.u1
o.v1
o.u2
o.v2
88
Operations Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
P.sta
opEr
Profile Status Menu
p.str
P.Str
p.ACr
PACr
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Profile Status
Profile Start
1 to 40
Instance 1
0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2520 4340 1
1
204
22001 uint
W
Profile Status
Action Request
None
Instance 1
0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2540 4360 1
0xB (11)
205
22011 uint
W
(148)
rEsU Resume
(147)
stp
StP
s.typ
S.typ
Profile Status
Current Step
View the currently
running step.
1 to 40
0 (none)
----
Instance 1
0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2526 4346 1
4
- - - - 22004 uint
R
Profile Status
Step Type
View the currently
running step type.
----
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2544 4364 1
0xD (13)
- - - - 22013 uint
R
(50)
t.sp1
t.SP1
Profile Status
*Target Set Point
Loop 1
View or change the
target set point of
the current step.
-1,999.000 to
0.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
-18.0C 2542 4362
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
0x7A
(122)
1
0xC (12)
- - - - 22012 float
RW
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
89
Operations Page
Display
t.sp2
t.SP2
AC.SP
AC.SP
p.sp2
P.SP2
hoUr
hoUr
in
Min
SEC
SEC
Ent1
Ent1
Ent2
Ent2
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Profile Status
*Target Set Point
Loop 2
View or change the
target set point of
the current step.
-1,999.000 to
0.0F
Instance 1
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
-18.0C - - - - 4434
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Profile Status
Produced Set Point
1
Display the current
set point, even if
the profile is ramping.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
- - - - 22005 float
R
Profile Status
Produced Set Point
2
Display the current
set point, even if
the profile is ramping.
-1,999.000 to
---9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
- - - - 22051 float
R
0x7A
(122)
1
0x30 (48)
- - - - 22048 float
RW
Profile Status
0 to 9999
Hours
Step time remaining
in hours.
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
- - - - 4494 1
0x4E (78)
- - - - 22078 uint
RW
Profile Status
0 to 59
Minutes
Step time remaining
in minutes.
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
- - - - 4492 1
0x4D (77)
- - - - 22077 uint
RW
Profile Status
0 to 59
Seconds
Step time remaining
in seconds.
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
- - - - 4490 1
0x4C (76)
- - - - 22076 uint
RW
Profile Status
*Event 1
View or change the
event output states.
Off
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2546 4366 1
0xE (14)
- - - - 22014 uint
RW
Profile Status
*Event 2
View or change the
event output states.
Off
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2548 4368 1
0xF (15)
- - - - 22015 uint
RW
90
Operations Page
Display
JC
JC
Parameter Name
Description
Profile Status
Jump Count Remaining
View the jump
counts remaining for the current
loop. In a profile
with nested loops,
this may not indicate the actual
jump counts remaining.
Range
0 to 9,999
Default
Modbus
Relative Address
CIP
PaClass
ProramInstance fibus
eter
Attribute Index
ID
hex (dec)
Data
Type
and
Access
**
----
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2538 4358 1
0xA (10)
- - - - 22010 uint
R
No Display
Profile Status
Off (62)
Profile State
Running (149)
Read current Profile Pause (146)
state.
----
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2524 4344 1
2
- - - - 22002 uint
R
No Display
Profile Status
1 to 25
Current File
0 (none)
Indicates current
file being executed.
----
Instance 1 0x7A
Map 1 Map 2 (122)
2522 4342 1
3
- - - - 22003 uint
R
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
91
Ai
sEt Analog Input Menu
1
Ai Analog Input (1 to 2)
sEn Sensor Type
Lin TC Linearization
rtL RTD Leads
Unit Units
s.Lo Scale Low
s.hi Scale High
P.EL
t.C
r.r
fiL
i.Er
dEC
able
Process Error Low
Value
Thermistor Curve
Resistance Range
Filter
Input Error Latching
Display Precision
d.bi
SEt
1
d.bi J1939 Instance (1 to 6)
Unit Unit
C.Idh CAN ID High Word
C.IdL CAN ID Low Word
* These parameters/prompts are available with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
92
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Lnr
sEt Linearization Menu
1
Lnr Linearization (1 to 2)
fn Function
sfn.a Source Function A
Si.a Source Instance A
sz.a Source Zone A
Unit Units
ip.1 Input Point 1
op.1 Output Point 1
ip.2 Input Point 2
op.2 Output Point 2
ip.3 Input Point 3
op.3 Output Point 3
ip.4 Input Point 4
op.4 Output Point 4
ip.5 Input Point 5
op.5 Output Point 5
ip.6 Input Point 6
op.6 Output Point 6
ip.7 Input Point 7
op.7 Output Point 7
ip.8 Input Point 8
op.8 Output Point 8
ip.q Input Point 9
op.q Output Point 9
ip.10 Input Point 10
op.10 Output Point 10
Pu
sEt Process Value
1
Pu Process Value (1 to 2)
fn Function
p.unt Pressure Units
a.unt Altitude Units
b.pr Barometric Pres-
sure
fiL Filter
dio
sEt Digital Input/Output
Menu
A*
L.Cr Clear Limit *
L.st Limit Status *
L.it Integrate with Sys-
tem
Loop
sEt Control Loop Menu
1
Loop Control Loop (1 to 2)
h.ag Heat Algorithm
C.ag Cool Algorithm
C.Cr Cool Output Curve
h.pb Heat Proportional
5
dio Digital Input/Output (5
h.hy
to 12)
dir Direction
C.pb
fn Function
fi Output Function In-
C.hy
stance
Band *
On/Off Heat Hyster-
esis *
Cool Proportional
Band *
On/Off Cool Hyster-
esis *
o.Ct Time Base Type
ti Time Integral *
o.tb Fixed Time Base
td Time Derivative *
o.Lo Low Power Scale
db Dead Band *
o.hi High Power Scale
t.tUn TRU-TUNE+ Enable
LEv Active Level
t.bnd TRU-TUNE+ Band
fn Action Function
t.gn TRU-TUNE+ Gain
fi Function Instance
a.tsp Autotune Set Point *
Li
t.agr Autotune Aggressive-
ness
sEt Limit Menu
p.dL Peltier Delay
Li Limit
r.En Remote Set Point
L.sd Sides
r.ty Remote Set Point
L.hy Hysteresis
Type
sp.Lh Maximum Set
Point Sfn.b Source Function B
Si.b Source Instance B
sp.LL Minimum Set
Point
Ufa Auto-to-Manual Pow-
er
Lh.s High Limit Set Point
faiL Input Error Power
*
LL.s Low Limit Set Point an Fixed Power
*
L.dE Open Loop Detect
Enable
sfn.a Source Function
L.dt Open Loop Detect
A*
Time
* These parameters/prompts are available with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
93
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Deviation
rp Ramp Action
r.sC Ramp Scale
r.rt Ramp Rate
L.sp Minimum Set Point
h.sp Maximum Set Point
C.sp Set Point*
id.s Idle Set Point *
sp.Lo Minimum Manual
Power
SP.hi Maximum Manual
Power
o.sp Manual Power *
C. Control Mode *
otpt
sEt Output Menu
1
otpt Output (1 to 4)
fn Function
fi
o.Ct
o.tb
o.Lo
o.hi
otpt
o.ty
fn
r.sr
fi
s.Lo
s.hi
r.Lo
r.hi
o.Ca
aL
sEt Alarm Menu
1
aL Alarm (1 to 4)
a.ty Type
stance
Loop Control Loop
a.hy Hysteresis
a.Lg Logic
a.sd Sides
a.Lo Low Set Point *
a.hi High Set Point *
a.La Latching
a.bL Blocking
a.si Silencing
a.dsp Display
a.dL Delay Time
a.CLr Clear Alarm *
a.sir Silence Alarm *
a.st Alarm State *
CUrr
sEt Current Menu
Current
Sides
Indicate Reading
Detection Thresh-
old
C.sC Input Scaling
C.ofs Heater Offset
C.si Monitored Output
CUrr
C.sd
C.Ur
C.dt
tr
SEt Timer Menu
ti.En Timer Enable
ti.St Timer Start Method
SFn.A Source Function A
Si.A Source Instance A
SFn.C Source Function C
Si.C Source Instance C
SFn.d Source Function D
Si.d Source Instance D
t.r Time Remaining
r.bS Ready Band State
rdy Ready Band
t.For Time Format
hoUr Hours
in Minutes
SEC Seconds
Ct.SP Closed Loop Timer
St
Set Point
Signal Time
at
sEt Math Menu
fn Function
Sfn.E Source Function E
Si.E Source Instance E
s.Lo Scale Low
S.hi Scale High
r.Lo Range Low
r.hi Range High
fiL Filter
sof
sEt Special Output Function
Menu
sof Special Output Func-
tion
fn Function
Sfn.a Source Function A
Si.a Source Instance A
Sfn.b Source Function B
Si.b Source Instance B
pon.a Input A Turn On
pof.a Input A Turn Off
pon.b Input B Turn On
pof.b Input B Turn Off
on.t Minimum On Time
of.t Minimum Off Time
t.t Valve Travel Time
db Dead Band
t.dL Time Delay
fUn
sEt Variable Menu
1
fUn Function Key (1 to 2)
LEv Active Level
Fn Action Function
fi Function Instance
* These parameters/prompts are available with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
94
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
1
FC.E DeviceNet Quick
Connect Enable
ip.f2 IP Fixed Address Part
sEt Global Menu
2
P.add Profibus Address
gLbL Global
A.LoC Profibus Address
C_f Display Units
ip.f3 IP Fixed Address Part
Lock
aC.Lf AC Line Frequency
3
stat Profibus Status
r.typ Ramping Type
ip.f4 IP Fixed Address Part J.ad J1939 Device Ad-
4
p.typ Profile Type
dress
gsE Guaranteed Soak En- ip.f5 IP Fixed Address Part J.baU J1939 Baud Rate
5
able
d.En J1939 Device Enable
gsd1 Guaranteed Soak De- ip.f6 IP Fixed Address Part tEds Read Enable
6
viation 1
C_f Display Units
gsd2 Guaranteed Soak De- ips1 IP Fixed Subnet Part
ap Data Map
1
viation 2
ips2 IP Fixed Subnet Part nU.s Non-volatile Save
si.a Source Instance A
2
si.b Source Instance B
rtC
ips3
IP
Fixed
Subnet
Part
sfnE Source Function E
sEt Real Time Clock
3
Si.E Source Instance E
hoUr Hours
ips4 IP Fixed Subnet Part
sfnF Source Function F
in Minutes
4
Si.F Source Instance F
ips5 IP Fixed Subnet Part do Day of Week
poti Power Off Time
5
sutb Synchronized Vari- ips6 IP Fixed Subnet Part
able Time Base
6
C.LEd Communications LED ipg1 IP Fixed Gateway
Action
Part 1
2onE Zone
ipg2 IP Fixed Gateway
Part 2
Chan Channel
ipg3 IP Fixed Gateway
d.prs Display Pairs
Part 3
d.ti Display Time
ipg4 IP Fixed Gateway
Usr.s Save Settings As
Part 4
Usr.r Restore Settings
ipg5 IP Fixed Gateway
From
Part 5
CO
ipg6 IP Fixed Gateway
Part 6
sEt Communications Menu
b.E Modbus TCP Enable
1
CO Communications (1 to Eip.E EtherNet/IP Enable
2)
ao.nb CIP Implicit Assem-
bly Output Member
pCoL Protocol
Quantity
a.ds Standard Bus Ad-
ai.nb CIP Implicit Assem-
dress
bly Input Member
ad. Modbus Address
Quantity
baUd Baud Rate
Ad.d DeviceNet Node
par Parity
Address
.hL Modbus Word Order BAUd Baud Rate Device-
iP. IP Address Mode
Net
ip.f1 IP Fixed Address Part
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
95
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
gLbL
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Ai
sEt
Analog Input Menu
sEn
SEn
Note:
There is no open
sensor protection
for process inputs.
a Milliamps dc
ThermoInstance 1
couple or Map 1 Map 2
Thermis- 368 368
tor
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
448
458
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
5
4005
uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
370 370
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
6
4006
uint
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
7
----
4007
uint
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x2A
(42)
4042
uint
RWES
(112)
pot Potentiometer 1
k (155)
thEr Thermistor
(229)
Lin
Lin
rt.L
rt.L
Unit
Unit
HK
nN
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
450
460
rR
sS
tT
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
372 372
2 2 (1)
3 3 (2)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
452
462
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 442
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 532
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
96
Setup Page
Display
s.Lo
S.Lo
s.hi
S.hi
r.Lo
r.Lo
r.hi
r.hi
p.EE
P.EE
p.EL
P.EL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
0.0
20.0
0.0
9,999
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Process Error Enable
Turn the Process Error Low feature on
or off.
Off
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
388
388
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
468
478
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
390
390
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
470
480
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
392
392
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
472
482
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
394
394
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
474
484
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
418
418
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
498
508
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
420
420
0.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
500
510
0x68 6
(104)
1 to 2
0xF (15)
4015
float
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x10
(16)
4016
float
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x11
(17)
4017
float
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x12
(18)
4018
float
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x1E
(30)
10
4030
uint
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x1F
(31)
11
4031
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
97
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
t.C
t.C
r.r
r.r
fiL
FiL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Thermistor Curve
Select a curve to apply to the thermistor
input.
Curve A
a Curve A (1451)
b Curve B (1452)
C Curve C (1453)
CUst Custom (180)
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Resistance Range
Set the maximum
resistance of the
thermistor input.
5 5K (1448)
10 10K (1360)
20 20K (1361)
40 40K (1449)
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
434
434
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
514
524
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
432
432
40K
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
512
522
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
386 386
0.5
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
466
476
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x26
(38)
----
4038
uint
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x25
(37)
----
4037
uint
RWES
4014
float
RWES
0x68 12
(104)
1 to 2
0xE (14)
Note:
Filter does not apply to the Limit
sensor but does
apply to all other
functions.
i.Er
i.Er
dEC
dEC
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Input Error Latching
Turn input error
latching on or off. If
latching is on, errors
must be manually
cleared.
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Display Precision
Set the precision of
the displayed value.
Whole
0 Whole (105)
0.0 Tenths (94)
0.00 Hundredths (40)
0.000 Thousandths
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
414 414
Off
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
494 504
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
398 398
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
478 488
(96)
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x1C
(28)
----
4028
uint
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x14
(20)
----
4020
uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
98
Setup Page
Display
i.Ca
i.CA
ain
Ain
i.Er
i.Er
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Calibration Offset *
Offset the input
reading to compensate for lead wire
resistance or other
factors that cause
the input reading to
vary from the actual
process value.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,110.555 to
5,555.000C
0.0
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Analog Input Value
*
View the process
value.
Note:
Ensure that the Error Status (below)
indicates no error
(61) when reading
this value using a
field bus protocol.
If an error exists,
the last known value
prior to the error
occurring will be returned.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
----
Analog Input (1 to 2)
Input Error *
View the cause of
the most recent error.
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
382 382
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
462 472
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
360 360
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
440 450
0x68 2
(104)
1 to 2
0xC (12)
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
1
Instance 1 0x68
Map 1 Map 2 (104)
362 442 1 to 2
Instance 2 2
4012
float
RWES
4001
float
R
4002
uint
R
Map 1 Map 2
362 452
ror (140)
E.CaL Bad Calibration
Data (139)
Er.ab Ambient Error
(9)
E.rtd RTD Error (141)
faiL Fail (32)
d.bi
sEt
Digital Bus Menu (J1939 CAN)
d.bi
d.bi
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
J1939 Instance
Select the desired
instance.
1 to 6
----
----
----
----
- - - - float
RW
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
99
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Units
Set the type of
units the sensor
will measure.
Absolute
Temperaperature (1540)
r.tp Relative Tem- ture
perature (1541)
pr Power (73)
pro Process (75)
rh Relative Humidity
(1538)
nonE None (61)
----
----
----
95005 uint
RWE
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
CAN ID High Word
0 to 65,535
----
----
----
94023 uint
RW
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
CAN ID Low Word
0 to 65,535
----
----
----
94022 uint
RW
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
Encoding Type
Slots
----
----
----
94005 uint
RWE
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Start Byte
1 to 8
1.0
----
----
----
94006 unsigned
byte
RWE
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Start Bit
1 to 8
1.0
----
----
----
94007 unsigned
byte
RWE
1 to 63
1.0
----
----
----
LEn
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Signal Length in
Bits
94008 unsigned
byte
RWE
S.n
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Scaling Numerator
1 to 65,535
For instance (1
to 3 and
6) = 128,
Instance
(4 and 5)
=1
----
----
----
- - - - uint
RWE
Unit
Unit
C.ldh
C.Idh
C.ldL
C.IdL
E.tp
E.tp
bytE
bytE
bit
bit
LEn
S.nM
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
100
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
1 to 65,535
For instance
(1 to 3
and 6)
= 4096,
Instance
(4 and 5)
=1
----
----
----
S.dEn
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Scaling Denominator
- - - - uint
RWE
OfSt
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Offset
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
1.0
----
----
----
93010 float
RWES
Digital Bus (1 to 4)
Filter
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
1.0
----
----
----
93011 float
RWE
Digital Bus (1 to 6)
CAN Units
F F (30)
C C (15)
nonE None (61)
For instance 5
= None,
instance
1 to 4
and 6 = C
----
----
----
93021 float
RWES
S.dEn
OFSt
FiL
FiL
CAn.u
CAn.u
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
101
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Bus (5)
Action Function
Program the digital
device to trigger an
action. Functions
respond to a level
state change or an
edge level change.
Range
Default
----
None
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
----
----
10003 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
102
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Lnr
sEt
Linearization Menu
Fn
Fn
SFn.A
SFn.A
Linearization (1 to
2)
Function
Set how this function will linearize
Source A.
Linearization (1 to
2)
Source Function A
Set the source for
the Linearization
function.
ai Analog Input
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3568
Off
(1482)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3638
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3560
(142)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3630
1 to 8
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3562
Note:
Instance 2 applies
if the 8th digit of
the part number =
7 and digit 9 is C,
J, R or P.
Si.a
Si.A
Linearization (1 to
2)
Source Instance A
Set the instance
of the function selected above.
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3632
Note:
Instance 2 applies
if the 8th digit of
the part number =
7 and digit 9 is C,
J, R or P.
Unit
Unit
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3616
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3686
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
5
155
34005 uint
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
1
- - - - 34001 uint
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
2
- - - - 34002 unsigned
8-bits
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x1D
(29)
156
34029 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
103
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
ip.1
ip.1
op.1
op.1
ip.2
ip.2
op.2
op.2
ip.3
ip.3
op.3
op.3
ip.4
ip.4
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 1
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 1.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 1
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 1.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 2
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 2.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 2
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 2.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 3
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 3.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 3
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 3.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 4
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 4.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3574
0.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3644
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3594
0.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3664
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3576
1.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3646
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3596
1.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3666
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3578
2.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3648
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3598
2.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3668
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3580
3.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3651
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
8
157
34008 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x12
(18)
158
34018 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
9
159
34009 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x13
(19)
160
34019 float
RWES
0x86 161
(134)
1 to 2
0xA (10)
34010 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x14
(20)
162
34020 float
RWES
0x86 163
(134)
1 to 2
0xB (11)
34011 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
104
Setup Page
Display
op.4
op.4
ip.5
ip.5
op.5
op.5
ip.6
ip.6
op.6
op.6
ip.7
ip.7
op.7
op.7
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 4
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 4.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 5
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 5.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 5
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 5.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 6
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 6.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 6
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 6.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 7
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 7.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 7
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 7.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3600
3.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3670
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3582
4.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3652
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3602
4.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3672
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3584
5.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3654
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3604
5.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3674
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3586
6.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3656
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3606
6.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3676
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x15
(21)
164
34021 float
RWES
0x86 165
(134)
1 to 2
0xC (12)
34012 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x16
(22)
166
34022 float
RWES
0x86 167
(134)
1 to 2
0xD (13)
34013 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x17
(23)
168
34023 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
E (14)
169
34014 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x18
(24)
170
34024 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
** These prompts are only available in this menu with firmware revision 11.0 and above.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
105
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
ip.8
ip.8
op.8
op.8
ip.q
ip.9
op.q
op.9
ip.10
ip.10
op.10
op.10
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 8
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 8.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 8
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 8.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 9
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 9.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 9
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 9.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Input Point 10
Set the value that
will be mapped to
output 10.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Linearization (1 to
2)
Output Point 10
Set the value that
will be mapped to
input 10.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3588
7.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3658
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3608
7.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3678
8.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3590
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3660
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3610
8.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3680
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3592
9.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3662
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3612
9.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3682
0x86 171
(134)
1 to 2
0xF (15)
34015 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x19
(25)
172
34025 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x10
(16)
173
34016 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x1A
(26)
174
34026 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x11
(17)
175
34017 float
RWES
0x86
(134)
1 to 2
0x1B
(27)
176
34027 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
106
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Pu
sEt
Process Value Menu
fn
Fn
p.unt
P.unt
a.unt
A.unt
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3320
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3390
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3334
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3404
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3336
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3406
0x7E
(126)
1 to 2
0x15
(21)
123
26021 uint
RWES
0x7E
(126)
1 to 2
0x1C
(28)
----
26028 uint
RWES
0x7E
(126)
1 to 2
0x1D
(29)
----
26029 uint
RWES
*** Pressure Altitude calculation is based on the International Standard Atmosphere 1976
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
107
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
b.pr
b.Pr
fiL
FiL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
14.7
0.0
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3338
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3408
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3330
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3400
0x7E
(126)
1 to 2
0x1E
(30)
----
26030 float
RWES
0x7E
(126)
1 to 2
0x1A
(26)
----
26026 float
RWES
*** Pressure Altitude calculation is based on the International Standard Atmosphere 1976
dio
sEt
Digital Input/Output Menu
dir
dir
Instance 5
0x6A 82
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1000 1120 5 to 12
1
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1
& Map 2)
equals +30
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 5
through 8 only
6001
uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
108
Setup Page
Display
fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Output (5 to
12)
Function
Select what function will drive this
output.
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 5
through 8 only
fi
Fi
Range
Default
Off
off Off (62)
aL Alarm (6)
hEat Heat (36)
CooL Cool (20)
sof.1 Special Function Output 1 (1532)
sof.2 Special Function Output 2 (1533)
tE.o1 Timer Event
Output 1 (1951)
tE.o2 Timer Event
Output 2 (1952)
tE.o3 Timer Event
Output 3 (1953)
Ent.a Profile Event
Out A (233)
Ent.b Profile Event
Out B (234)
h.Er Heater Error
(184)
Digital Output (5 to 1 to 4
12)
Output Function
Instance
Set the instance
of the function selected above.
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 5
through 8 only
o.Ct
o.Ct
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 5
0x 6A 83
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1008 1128 5 to 12
5
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6005
uint
RWES
Instance 5
0x6A 84
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1010 1130 5 to 12
6
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6006
uint
RWES
Instance 5
0x6A 85
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1002 1122 5 to 12
2
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6002
uint
RWES
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 5
through 8 only
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
109
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
o.tb
o.tb
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
1.0
Instance 5
0x6A 86
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1004 1124 5 to 12
3
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6003
float
RWES
0.0
Instance 5
0x6A 87
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1016 1136 5 to 12
9
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6009
float
RWES
100.0
Instance 5
0x6A 88
Map 1 Map 2 (106)
1018 1138 5 to 12
A (10)
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +30
6010
float
RWES
Digital Input (5 to 6)
Active Level
Select which action
will be interpreted
as a true state.
High
Instance 5
Map 1 Map 2
1320 1560
10001 uint
RW
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 5
through 8 only
o.Lo
o.Lo
o.hi
o.hi
LEu
LEv
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +20
0x6E
(110)
5 to 6
1
137
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
110
Setup Page
Display
LEu
LEv
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Input (7 to
12)
Active Level
Select which action
will be interpreted
as a true state.
Range
Default
Instance 7
Map 1 Map 2
1400 1640
High
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Offset to
next instance
Map 2 equals
+20
Note:
Modbus Map 1 has
instances 7 and 8
only
0x6E
(110)
7 to C
(12)
1
137
10001 uint
RW
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
111
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Input (5 to 6)
Action Function
Select the function that will be
triggered by a true
state for Digital Inputs 5 to 6.
Range
Default
Instance 5
Map 1 Map 2
1324 1564
None
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
(1077)
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +20
0x6E
(110)
5 to 6
3
138
10003 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
112
Setup Page
Display
Fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Digital Input (7 to
12)
Action Function
Select the function that will be
triggered by a true
state for Digital Inputs 7 through 12.
Note:
Modbus Map 1
has instances 7
through 10 only
Range
Default
Instance 7
Map 1 Map 2
1404 1644
None
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
(1077)
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +20
0x6E
(110)
7 to C
(12)
3
138
10003 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
113
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Fi
Fi
Fi
Fi
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Digital Input (5 to 6) 0 to 40
Function Instance
Select which Digital
Input will be triggered by a true
state.
Digital Input (7 to
0 to 40
12)
Function Instance
Select which Digital
Input will be triggered by a true
state.
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 5
Map 1 Map 2
1326 1566
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +20
Instance 7
Map 1 Map 2
1406 1646
Offset to
next instance
(Map 1 & Map
2) equals +20
Note:
Modbus Map 1 has
instances 7 through
10 only
0x6E
(110)
5 to 6
4
139
10004 uint
RWES
0x6E
(110)
7 to C
(12)
4
139
10004 uint
RWES
Li
sEt
Limit Menu
L.sd
L.Sd
L.hy
L.hy
sp.Lh
SP.Lh
Limit (1)
Sides
Select which side or
sides of the process
value will be monitored.
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
688
728 1
5
40
12005 uint
RWES
Limit (1)
0.001 to 9,999.000F 3.0F or
Hysteresis
or units
units
Set the hysteresis
0.001 to 5,555.000C 2.0C
for the limit function. This determines how far into
the safe range the
process value must
move before the
limit can be cleared.
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
682
722 1
2
41
12002 float
RWES
Limit (1)
-1,999.000 to
Maximum Set Point 9,999.000
Set the high end of
the limit set point
range.
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
696
736 1
9
42
12009 float
RWES
Both
9,999.000
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
114
Setup Page
Display
sp.LL
SP.LL
Lh.s
Lh.S
LL.s
LL.S
sfn.a
SFn.A
si.a
Si.A
L.Cr
LCr
L.st
L.St
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Limit (1)
Minimum Set Point
Set the low end of
the limit set point
range.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
Limit (1)
High Limit Set
Point *
Set the high process
value that will trigger the limit.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
0.0F or
units
-18.0C
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
686
726 1
4
39
12004 float
RWES
Limit (1 )
Low Limit Set
Point *
Set the low process
value that will trigger the limit.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
0.0F or
units
-18.0C
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
684
724 1
3
38
12003 float
RWES
Limit (1)
nonE None (61)
Source Function A *
dio Digital I/O
Set the source for
(1142)
the limit reset funcfUn Function Key
tion.
(1001)
None
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
- - - - 748 1
0x0F
(15)
----
12015 uint
RWES
Limit (1)
1 to 12
Source Instance A *
Set the instance of
the function selected above.
0x70
(112)
1
0x10
(16)
----
12016 uint
RWES
Limit (1)
Clear Limit *
Clear limit once
limit condition is
safe.
----
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
680
720 1
1
----
12014 uint
W
Limit (1)
Limit Status *
Reflects whether
or not the limit is
in a safe or failed
mode.
----
Instance 1 0x70
Map 1 Map 2 (112)
- - - - 744 1
0x0D
(13)
----
12013 uint
R
----
12010 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
115
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
L.it
L.it
No Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Limit (1)
Integrate with System
In a limit state the
controller will turn
off the outputs,
terminate an active profile and
freeze PID and
TRU-TUNE+ calculations.
no No (59)
yES Yes (106)
Limit (1)
Limit State
Clear limit once
limit condition is
cleared.
No
----
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
694
734
0x70
(112)
1
8
----
12008 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
690
730
0x70
(112)
1
6
----
12006 uint
R
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1884 2364
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
3
72
8003
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
4
73
8004
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
5
----
8038
uint
RWES
Loop
sEt
Control Loop Menu
h.ag
h.Ag
C.ag
C.Ag
C.Cr
C.Cr
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Heat Algorithm
Set the heat control method.
PID
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Cool Algorithm
Set the cool control
method.
Off
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Cool Output Curve
Select a cool
output curve to
change the responsiveness of
the system.
Off
off Off (62)
Cr.a Non-linear Curve
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1954 2434
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1886 2366
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1956 2436
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1888 2368
1 (214)
Cr.b Non-linear Curve
2 (215)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1958 2438
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
116
Setup Page
Display
h.pb
h.Pb
h.hy
h.hy
C.pb
C.Pb
C.hy
C.hy
Parameter Name
Description
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Heat Proportional
Band *
Set the PID proportional band for
the heat outputs.
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1890 2370
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1960 2440
Control Loop (1 to
0.001 to 9,999.000F 3.0F or
2)
or units
units
On / Off Heat Hys- 0.001 to 5,555.000C 2.0C
teresis *
Set the control
switching hysteresis for on-off control. This determines how far into
the on region
the process value
needs to move
before the output
turns on.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1900 2380
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Cool Proportional
Band *
Set the PID proportional band for
the cool outputs.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1892 2372
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1970 2450
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1962 2442
Control Loop (1 to
0.001 to 9,999.000F 3.0F or
2)
or units
units
On/Off Cool Hys0.001 to 5,555.000C 2.0C
teresis *
Set the control
switching hysteresis for on-off control. This determines how far into
the on region
the process value
needs to move
before the output
turns on.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1902 2382
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1972 2522
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
6
65
8009
float
RWES
0x97
66
(151)
1 to 2
0xB (11)
8010
float
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
7
67
8012
float
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0xC
(12)
68
8013
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
117
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
ti
ti
td
td
db
db
t.tUn
t.tUn
Parameter Name
Description
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Time Integral *
Set the PID integral for the outputs.
Range
Default
180 seconds per
repeat
0 to 9,999 seconds
per repeat
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1894 2374
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1964 2444
Control Loop (1 to
0 to 9,999 seconds
2)
Time Derivative *
Set the PID derivative time for the
outputs.
0
seconds
Control Loop (1 to
-1,000.0 to
2)
1,000.0F or units
Dead Band *
-556 to 556C
Set the offset to
the proportional
band. With a negative value, both
heating and cooling outputs are
active when the
process value is
near the set point.
A positive value
keeps heating and
cooling outputs
from fighting each
other.
0.0
Control Loop (1 to
2)
TRU-TUNE+ Enable
Enable or disable
the TRU-TUNE+
adaptive tuning
feature.
No
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1896 2376
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1966 2446
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1898 2378
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1968 2448
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1910 2390
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1980 2460
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
8
69
8006
float
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
9
70
8007
float
RWES
0x97
71
(151)
1 to 2
0xA (10)
8008
float
RWES
0x97 - - - (151)
1 to 2
10 (16)
8022
uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
118
Setup Page
Display
t.bnd
t.bnd
t.gn
t.gn
a.tsp
A.tSP
t.agr
t.Agr
p.dL
P.dL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Control Loop (1 to
0 to 100
2)
TRU-TUNE+ Band
Set the range, centered on the set
point, within which
TRU-TUNE+ will be
in effect. Use this
function only if the
controller is unable
to adaptive tune
automatically.
Control Loop (1 to
1 to 6
2)
TRU-TUNE+ Gain
Select the responsiveness of
the TRU-TUNE+
adaptive tuning
calculations. More
responsiveness may
increase overshoot.
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Autotune Set Point
*
Set the set point
that the autotune
will use, as a percentage of the
current set point.
90.0
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1912 2392
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1982 2462
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1914 2394
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1984 2464
50 to 200%
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1918 2398
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1988 2468
Control Loop (1 to
Undr Under damped Critical
2)
(99)
Autotune AggresCrit Critical
siveness
damped (21)
Select the aggresovEr Over damped
siveness of the
autotuning calcula- (69)
tions.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1916 2396
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Peltier Delay
Set a value that
will cause a delay when switching from heat PID
mode to cool PID
mode.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1934 2414
0.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1986 2466
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2004 2484
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x11
(17)
----
8034
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x12
(18)
----
8035
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x14
(20)
----
8025
float
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x13
(19)
----
8024
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x1C
(28)
----
8051
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
119
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
r.En
r.En
r.ty
r.ty
SFn.b
SFn.b
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
No
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2200 2680
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
0x15
(21)
48
7021
uint
RWES
Auto
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2202 2682
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
0x16
(22)
----
7022
uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2204 2684
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
0x17
(23)
- - - - 7023
uint
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
0x18
(24)
- - - - 7024
unsigned
8-bits
RWES
put (1993)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2284 2764
Note:
Applies to models
with the 8th digit
of the part number
=7
Si.b
Si.b
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2206 3562
1 to 6
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2286 3632
Note:
Applies to models
with the 8th digit
of the part number
=7
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
120
Setup Page
Display
Ufa
UFA
faiL
FAiL
an
MAn
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Auto-to-Manual
Power
Select what the
controller outputs will do when
the user switches
control to manual
mode.
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Input Error Power
Select what the
controller outputs
will do when an input error switches
control to manual
mode.
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Fixed Power
Set the manual
output power level
that will take effect if an input error failure occurs
while User Failure
Action is set to
Fixed Power.
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2182 2662
power to 0% (62)
bpLs Bumpless
transfer, maintains
same output power,
if it was less than 75%
and stable, otherwise
0% (14)
an Fixed Power,
sets output power to
Fixed Power setting
(54)
UsEr User, sets
output power to last
open-loop set point
the user entered
(100)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2262 2742
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2184 2664
power to 0% (62)
bpLs Bumpless
transfer, maintains
same output power,
if it was less than 75%
and stable, otherwise
0% (14)
an Fixed Power,
sets output power to
Fixed Power setting
(54)
UsEr User, sets
output power to last
open-loop set point
the user entered
(100)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2264 2744
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2180 2660
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2260 2740
0x6B - - - (107)
1 to 2
0xC (12)
7012
uint
RWES
0x6B - - - (107)
1 to 2
0xD (13)
7013
uint
RWES
0x6B - - - (107)
1 to 2
0xB (11)
7011
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
121
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
L.dE
L.dE
No Display
L.dt
L.dt
L.dd
L.dd
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Open Loop Detect
Enable
Select Yes to detect conditions that
prevent the process from changing
in specified time
frame by a specified amount when
PID power is at
100%. An open loop
detect error will
disable the control
loop.
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Open Loop Error
Status
View the cause of
the most recent
error.
none (61)
Open Loop (1274)
Reversed Sensor
(1275)
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1922 2402
No
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1992 2472
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1928 2408
----
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1998 2478
Control Loop (1 to
0 to 3,600 seconds
2)
Open Loop Detect
Time
Process must deviate by the Open
Loop Detect Deviation value in
the specified time,
while at 100% PID
power, otherwise
an Open Loop Detect event is triggered.
240
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Open Loop Detect
Deviation
Process must deviate by this value
in the Open Loop
Detect Time while
at 100% PID power
to prevent an open
loop error.
10.0F or Instance 1
units
Map 1 Map 2
6.0C
1926 2406
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1924 2404
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1994 2474
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,110.555 to
5,555.000C
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1996 2476
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x16
(22)
74
8039
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x19
(25)
----
8048
uint
R
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x17
(23)
75
8040
uint
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
0x18
(24)
76
8041
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
122
Setup Page
Display
rp
rP
r.sC
r.SC
r.rt
r.rt
L.sp
L.SP
h.sp
h.SP
C.sp
C.SP
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Control Loop (1 to
off Off (62)
2)
str Startup (88)
Ramp Action
stpt Set Point
Select when the
Change (85)
controller's set
point will ramp to both Both (13)
the defined end set
point.
Off
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Ramp Scale
Select the scale of
the ramp rate.
Minutes
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2186 2666
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2266 2746
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2188 2668
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2268 2748
Control Loop (1 to
0.0 to 9,999.000F or 1.0F or
2)
units
units
Ramp Rate
0.0 to 5,555.000C
1.0C
Set the rate for the
set point ramp. Set
the time units for
the rate with the
Ramp Scale parameter.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2192 2672
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2272 2752
0x6B 56
(107)
1 to 2
0xE (14)
7014
uint
RWES
0x6B 57
(107)
1 to 2
0xF (15)
7015
uint
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
0x11
(17)
58
7017
float
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
3
52
7003
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Minimum Set Point
Set the minimum
value of the closed
loop set point
range.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
-1,999F
Instance 1
or units Map 1 Map 2
-1,128C 2164 2644
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Maximum Set Point
Set the maximum
value of the closed
loop set point
range.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
9,999F
or units
5,537C
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2166 2646
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2246 2726
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
4
53
7004
float
RWES
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Set Point *
Set the set point
that the controller
will automatically
control to.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
75.0F
or units
24.0C
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2160 2640
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
1
49
7001
float
RWES
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2244 2724
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2240 2720
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
123
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
id.s
id.S
sp.Lo
SP.Lo
sp.hi
SP.hi
o.sp
o.SP
C.
C.M
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Idle Set Point *
Set a closed loop
set point that can
be triggered by an
event state.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
75.0F
or units
24.0C
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Minimum Manual
Power
Set the minimum
value of the openloop set point
range.
-100.0 to 100.0%
-100
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Maximum Manual
Power
Set the maximum
value of the openloop set point
range.
-100.0 to 100.0%
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Manual Power *
Set a fixed level
of output power
when in manual
(open-loop) mode.
-100.0 to 100.0%
(heat and cool) 0 to
100.0% (heat only)
-100.0 to 0% (cool
only)
0.0
Control Loop (1 to
2)
Control Mode *
Select the method
that this loop will
use to control.
Auto
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2176 2656
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2197 2736
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2168 2648
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2248 2728
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2170 2650
100
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2250 2730
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2162 2642
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2242 2722
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1880 2360
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1950 2430
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
9
50
7009
float
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
5
54
7005
float
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
6
55
7006
float
RWES
0x6B
(107)
1 to 2
2
51
7002
float
RWES
0x97
(151)
1 to 2
1
63
8001
uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
124
Setup Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
otpt
SEt
Output Menu
Fn
Fn
Output Digital (1
to 4)
Function
Select what function will drive this
output.
Note:
When digit 9 in
the part number
= L, output 4 is
always fixed as
a limit function.
In addition, only
output 3 can be
programmed as a
limit function.
Fi
Fi
o.Ct
o.Ct
Output 1
Instance 1
oFF Off (62)
Heat
Map
1 Map 2
AL Alarm (6)
Output
2
888
1008
hEat Heat (36)
Alarm
Cool Cool (20)
SoF.1 Special Func- Output 3 Offset to
83
6005 uint
RWES
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
6
84
6006 uint
RWES
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
2
85
6002 uint
RWES
next instance
tion Output 1 (1532) - Off
Output
4
(Map 1 & Map
SoF.2 Special FuncOff
2) equals +30
tion Output 2 (1533)
tE.o1 Timer Event 1
(1951)
tE.o2 Timer Event 2
(1952)
tE.o3 Timer Event 3
(1953)
Ent.A Profile Event
Out A (233)
Ent.b Profile Event
Out B (234)
Li Limit (126)
Output Digital (1
1 to 4
to 4)
Output Function Instance
Set the instance of
the function selected above.
Output Digital (1
to 4)
Time Base Type
Set the time base
type. This parameter is only used with
PID control, but can
be set anytime.
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
5
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
890 1010
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 & Map 2)
equals +30
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
882 1002
Time
Base
(34)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 & Map 2)
equals +30
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
125
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
o.tb
o.tb
o.Lo
o.Lo
o.hi
o.hi
o.ty
o.ty
Fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Output Digital (1
0.1 to 60.0 seconds
1.0 sec.
Instance 1
to 4)
(solid-state relay or for SSR Map 1 Map 2
Fixed Time Base
switched dc)
or swdc 884 1004
Set the time base
5.0 to 60.0 seconds
5.0 for
for fixed-time-base
(mechanical relay
relay
Offset to
control.
or NO-ARC power
next incontrol)
stance (Map
1 & Map 2)
equals +30
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
3
86
6003 float
RWES
Output Digital (1
0.0 to 100.0%
to 4)
Low Power Scale
The power output
will never be less
than the value
specified and will
represent the value
at which output
scaling begins.
0.0%
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
9
87
6009 float
RWES
Output Digital (1
0.0 to 100.0%
to 4)
High Power Scale
The power output
will never be greater than the value
specified and will
represent the value
at which output
scaling stops.
100.0%
0x6A
(106)
1 to 4
0x0A
(10)
88
6010 float
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
1
95
18001 uint
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
2
96
18002 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
896 1016
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 & Map 2)
equals +30
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
898 1018
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 & Map 2)
equals +30
Output Process (1
or 3)
Type
Select whether the
process output will
operate in volts or
milliamps.
Volts
uoLt Volts (104)
A Milliamps (112)
Output Process (1
or 3)
Function
Set the type of
function that will
drive this output.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
720
840
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
800
920
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
722
842
Off
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
802
922
Out A (233)
rt Retransmit
(213)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
126
Setup Page
Display
r.Sr
r.Sr
Fi
Fi
S.Lo
S.Lo
S.hi
S.hi
Parameter Name
Description
Output Process (1
or 3)
Retransmit Source
Select the value
that will be retransmitted.
Range
Default
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
724
844
Analog
Input
Ai Analog Input
(142)
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
804
924
Output Process (1
1 to 4
or 3)
Function Instance
Set the instance of
the function selected above.
Output Process (1
-100.0 to 100.0
or 3)
Scale Low
Set the scale low
for process output
in electrical units.
This value; in volts
or milliamps, will
correspond to 0%
PID power output or
range low retransmit output.
0.00
Output Process (1
-100.0 to 100.0
or 3)
Scale High
Set the scale high
for process output
in
electrical units. This
value; in volts or
milliamps, will correspond to 100% PID
power output or
range high retransmit output.
10.00
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
726
846
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
806
926
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
736
856
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
816
936
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
738
858
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
818 938
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
3
97
18003 uint
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
4
98
18004 uint
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
9
99
18009 float
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
0x0A
(10)
100
18010 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
127
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
r.Lo
r.Lo
r.hi
r.hi
o.CA
o.CA
Range
Default
Output Process (1
-1,999.000 to
0.0F or
or 3)
9,999.000F or units units
Range Low
-1,128.000 to
-18C
Set the minimum
5,537.000C
value of the retransmit value
range in process
units. When the
retransmit source
is at this value, the
retransmit output
will be at its Scale
Low value.
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
740
860
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
0x0B
(11)
101
18011 float
RWES
Output Process (1
-1,999.000 to
100.0F
Instance 1
or 3)
9,999.000F or units or units Map 1 Map 2
Range High
-1,128.000 to
38.0C
742
862
Set the maximum
5,537.000C
Instance 3
value of the reMap 1 Map 2
transmit value
822
942
range in process
units. When the
retransmit source
is at this value, the
retransmit output
will be at its Scale
High value.
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
0x0C
(12)
102
18012 float
RWES
Output Process (1
or 3)
Calibration Offset
Set an offset value
for a process output.
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
7
105
18007 float
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0xF (15)
20
9015 uint
RWES
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
820
940
-1,999.000 to
0.0F or
9,999.000F or units units
-1,110.555 to
0.0C
5,555.000C
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
732
852
Off
oFF Off (62)
Pr.AL Process Alarm
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1508 1908
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
812
932
AL
SEt
Alarm Menu
A.ty
A.ty
Alarm (1 to 4)
Type
Select whether the
alarm trigger is a
fixed value or will
track the set point.
(76)
dE.AL Deviation
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
Alarm (24)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
128
Setup Page
Display
Sr.A
Sr.A
Parameter Name
Description
Alarm (1 to 4)
Alarm Source
Select what will
trigger this alarm.
Range
Default
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1512 1912
Lnr Linearization
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
(238)
Note:
When using Devia- Pu Process Value
(241)
tion Alarms with
Pr Power (73)
Differential control, the Alarm
d.bi Digital Bus InSource must be set put (1993)
to Process Value. Ld.Cu Load Current
RMS (179)
CUrr Current Read
is Sample and Hold
(22)
is.A
iS.A
Loop
LooP
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Alarm (1 to 4)
1 or 2
Alarm Source Instance
Set the instance of
the function selected above.
Alarm (1 to 4)
Control Loop
Set the instance
of the Set Point
Closed, Control
Loop, that will be
referenced by the
deviation alarm.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1514 1914
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
1 to 2
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1524 1924
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
Note:
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0x11
(17)
21
9017 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 2
0x12
(18)
22
9018 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 2
0x17
(23)
23
9023 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
3
24
9003 float
RWES
Not available on
single loop models.
A.hy
A.hy
Alarm (1 to 4)
0.001 to 9,999.000F 1.0F or
Hysteresis
or units
units
Set the hysteresis
0.001 to 5,555.000C 1.0C
for an alarm. This
determines how far
into the safe region
the process value
needs to move before the alarm can
be cleared.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1484 1884
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, Map 2
+60)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
129
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
A.Lg
A.Lg
A.Sd
A.Sd
A.Lo
A.Lo
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Alarm (1 to 4)
Logic
Select what the
output condition
will be during the
alarm state.
AL.C Energize on
Alarm (1 to 4)
Sides
Select which side
or sides will trigger
this alarm.
Alarm (1 to 4)
Low Set Point
If Type (Setup
Page, Alarm Menu)
is set to:
Process - set the
process value that
will trigger a low
alarm.
Deviation - set
the span of units
from the closed
loop set point
that will trigger
a low alarm. A
negative set point
represents a value
below closed
loop set point. A
positive set point
represents a value
above closed loop
set point.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or
units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Close On
Instance 1
Alarm
Map 1 Map 2
1488 1888
alarm (17)
AL.o De-energize on
alarm (66)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1486 1886
Both
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map 2
+60)
32.0F
Instance 1
or units Map 1 Map 2
0.0C
1482 1882
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 +50, Map
2 +60)
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
5
25
9005 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
4
26
9004 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
2
18
9002
float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
130
Setup Page
Display
A.hi
A.hi
A.LA
A.LA
A.bL
A.bL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Alarm (1 to 4)
High Set Point
If Type (Setup
Page, Alarm Menu)
is set to:
Process - set the
process value that
will trigger a high
alarm.
Deviation - set the
span of units from
the closed loop
set point that
will trigger a high
alarm.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or
units
-1,128.000 to
5,537.000C
Alarm (1 to 4)
Latching
Turn latching on or
off. A latched alarm
has to be turned off
by the user.
nLAt Non-Latching
Alarm (1 to 4)
Blocking
Select when an
alarm will be
blocked. After startup and/or after the
set point changes,
the alarm will be
blocked until the
process value enters
the normal range.
Off
oFF Off (62)
Str Startup (88)
StPt Set Point (85)
both Both (13)
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
300.0F
Instance 1
or units Map 1 Map 2
150.0C
1480 1880
Offset to
next instance (Map
1) equals
+50
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
1
19
9001
float
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
7
27
9007 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
8
28
9008 uint
RWES
Offset to
next instance (Map
2) equals
+60
NonInstance 1
Latching Map 1 Map 2
1492 1892
(60)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, for Map
2 equals
+60)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1494 1894
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, for Map
2 equals
+60)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
131
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
A.Si
A.Si
A.dSP
A.dSP
A.dL
A.dL
a.CLr
A.Clr
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Alarm (1 to 4)
Silencing
Turn silencing on to
allow the user to
disable this alarm.
Alarm (1 to 4)
Display
Display an alarm
message when an
alarm is active.
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1490 1890
Off
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, for Map
2 equals
+60)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1510 1910
On
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, for Map
2 equals
+60)
Alarm (1 to 4)
0 to 9,999 seconds
Delay Time
Set the span of time
that the alarm will
be delayed after
the process value
exceeds the alarm
set point.
Alarm (1 to 4)
Clear Alarm
Write to this register to clear an
alarm
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1520 1920
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, for Map
2 equals
+60)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1504 1904
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals
+50, Map 2
equals +60)
Note:
If an alarm is setup to latch when
active a.CLr will
appear on the display.
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
6
29
9006 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0x10
(16)
30
9016 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0x15
(21)
31
9021 uint
RWES
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
0xD
(13)
----
9013
uint
W
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
132
Setup Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
a.sir
A.Sir
Alarm (1 to 4)
Silence Alarm
Write to this register to silence an
alarm
Range
Default
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1506 1906
----
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals
+50, Map 2
equals +60)
Note:
If an alarm is
setup to silence
alarm when active
a.sir will appear
on the display.
a.st
A.St
Alarm (1 to 4)
Alarm State
Current state of
alarm
----
CU.r
C.dt
C.dt
0x6D
(109)
1 to 4
9
----
9014
uint
W
9009
uint
R
For further description and usage tips see the CT Application Note in this User's Guide.
Current Menu
CU.r
0x6D
---(109)
1 to 4
0xE (14)
Note:
SEt
C.Sd
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1496 1896
Offset to
next instance
(Map1 1
equals
+50, Map 2
equals +60)
CUrr
C.Sd
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Current (1)
Sides
Select which side or
sides will be monitored.
off
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1128 1368
0x73
(115)
1
5
145
15005 uint
RWES
Current (1)
Indicate Reading
Use Indicate Reading
to display solid-state
relay (SSR) failure
and heater failure
messages.
no No (59)
yEs Yes (106)
no
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1126 1366
0x73
(115)
1
4
146
15004 uint
RWES
Current (1)
Input Detection
Threshold
For factory adjustment only.
3 to 59
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1142 1382
0x73
(115)
1
0xC (12)
147
15012 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
133
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
C.SC
C.SC
C.oFs
C.oFS
C.Si
C.Si
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Current (1)
0 to 9,999.000
Input Scaling
Adjust scaling to
match the transformer's high range.
50.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1162 1402
0x73
(115)
1
0x16
(22)
148
15022 float
RWES
Current (1)
Heater Offset
Calibrate the current reading with
an offset value.
0.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1140 1380
0x73
(115)
1
0xB (11)
149
15011 float
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1156 1396
0x73
(115)
1
0x13
(19)
150
15019 uint
RWES
-9,999.000 to
9,999.000
Current (1)
1 to 12
Monitored Output
Select which output
instance the current
transformer will
monitor.
tr
SEt
Timer Menu
ti.En
ti.En
ti.St
ti.St
Timer (1)
Timer Enable
Enable the timer
function.
Yes
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4626 8556
0x83
(131)
1
0x1D
(29)
----
31029 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
Timer Start Method
Select what will
start the timer.
id Immediate
Immediate
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4628 8558
0x83
(131)
1
0x1E
(30)
----
31030 uint
RWES
Function
Key
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4570 8500
0x83
---(131)
1
0x01 (1)
31001 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4574 8504
0x83
---(131)
1
0x03 (3)
31003 uint
RWES
(1049)
(1950)
Pr Power (73)
SFn.A
SFn.A
Si.A
Si.A
Timer (1)
Source Function A
Select which input
will start or terminate the timer.
Timer (1)
Source Instance A
Select an instance
of Function A.
1 to 24
(1001)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
134
Setup Page
Display
SFn.C
SFn.C
Parameter Name
Description
Timer (1)
Source Function C
Select the analog
source for the ready
band.
Range
Default
Pu Process Value
(241)
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Process
Value
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4630 8560
0x83
(131)
1
0x1F
(31)
----
31031 uint
RWES
Lnr Linearization
(238)
Si.C
Si.C
SFn.d
SFn.D
Si.d
Si.d
t.r
t.r
r.bS
r.bS
rdy
rdY
Timer (1)
Source Instance C
Select an instance
of Function C.
1 to 24
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4634 8564
0x83
(131)
1
0x21
(33)
----
31033 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
Source Function D
Select which input
will acknowledge
the ready band.
Function
Key
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4632 8562
0x83
(131)
1
0x20
(32)
----
31032 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
Source Instance D
Select an instance
of Function D.
1 to 24
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4636 8566
0x83
(131)
1
0x22
(34)
----
31034 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
Time Remaining
Display the time
remaining on the
timer.
00:00 to 99:59
0x83
(131)
1
0x15
(21)
----
31021 string
R
Timer (1)
Ready Band State
Display whether the
process value is in
the ready band.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4612 8542
0x83
(131)
1
0x16
(22)
----
31022 uint
R
Timer (1)
Ready Band
Set the how close
the process value
must be to the
closed loop timer
set point to be in
the ready band.
0.000 to 9999.000F
or units
0.000 to 5555.000C
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4614 8544
0x83
(131)
1
0x17
(23)
----
31023 float
RWES
(1001)
nonE None (61)
dio Digital I/O
(1142)
----
----
5.000
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
135
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
t.For
t.For
hoUr
hoUr
in
Min
SEC
SEC
Ct.SP
Ct.SP
St
St
Parameter Name
Description
Timer (1)
Time Format
Select the time format.
Range
Default
tS Time
Minutes:Seconds
(1943)
th Time
Hours:Minutes
(1944)
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Time
Instance 1
Minutes: Map 1 Map 2
Seconds 4616 8546
0x83
(131)
1
0x18
(24)
----
31024 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
0 to 99
Hours
Set the timer period
hours.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4618 8548
0x83
(131)
1
0x19
(25)
----
31025 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
0 to 59
Minutes
Set the timer period
minutes.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4620 8550
0x83
(131)
1
0x1A
(26)
----
31026 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
0 to 59
Seconds
Set the timer period
seconds.
10
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4622 8552
0x83
(131)
1
0x1B
(27)
----
31027 uint
RWES
-1999.000 to
75
9999.000F or units
-1110.555 to
5555.000C
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4624 8554
0x83
(131)
1
0x1C
(28)
----
31028 float
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4658 8588
0x83
(131)
1
0x2D
(45)
----
31045 uint
RWES
Timer (1)
Closed Loop Timer
Set Point
Set the set point
that will be in effect during the
timer period.
Timer (1)
1 to 3600 Seconds
Signal Time
Set the period of
time that a signal
output to be activated after the
timer period is complete. Assign a digital output for this
function in Timer
Event Output 3.
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
136
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
At
SEt
Math Menu
Fn
Fn
SFn.E
SFn.E
si.E
Si.E
S.Lo
S.Lo
S.hi
S.hi
r.Lo
r.Lo
r.hi
r.hi
Math (1)
Function
Set the operator
that will be applied
to the sources.
Math (1)
Source Function E
Set the type of
function that will
be used for this
source.
Off
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3040
0x7D
(125)
1
0x15
(21)
128
25021 uint
RWES
None
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3008
0x7D
(125)
1
5
----
25005 uint
RWES
(1371)
(1001)
Math (1)
Source Instance E
Set the instance of
the function selected above.
1 to 12
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3018
0x7D
(125)
1
0xA (10)
Math (1)
Scale Low
This value will correspond to Output
Range Low.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
0.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3046
0x7D
(125)
1
0x18
(24)
129
25024 float
RWES
Math (1)
Scale High
This value will correspond to Output
Range High.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
1.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3048
0x7D
(125)
1
0x19
(25)
130
25025 float
RWES
Math (1)
Range Low
This value will correspond to Input
Scale Low.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
0.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3050
0x7D
(125)
1
0x1A
(26)
131
25026 float
RWES
Math (1)
Range High
This value will correspond to Input
Scale High.
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000
1.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3052
0x7D
(125)
1
0x1B
(27)
132
25027 float
RWES
25010 float
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
137
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
FiL
FiL
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Math (1)
0.0 to 60.0 seconds
Filter
Filtering smooths
out the output signal of this function
block. Increase the
time to increase filtering.
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
0.0
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3054
0x7D
(125)
1
0x1C
(28)
----
25028 float
RWES
Off
oFF Off (62)
uA.C Motorized Valve
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3856
0x87
(135)
1
9
181
35009 uint
RWES
None
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3840
0x87
(135)
1
1
182
35001 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3844
0x87
(135)
1
3
183
35003 uint
RWES
None
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3842
0x87
(135)
1
2
184
35002 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3846
0x87
(135)
1
4
185
35004 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3874
0x87
(135)
1
0x12
(18)
186
35018 float
RWES
sof
sEt
Special Output Function Menu
Fn
Fn
SFn.A
SFn.A
Si.A
Si.A
SFn.b
SFn.b
Si.b
Si.b
Pon.A
Pon.A
(1508)
Co.C Compressor
Control (1506)
(160)
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
138
Setup Page
Display
PoF.A
PoF.A
Pon.b
Pon.b
PoF.b
PoF.b
on.t
on.t
oF.t
oF.t
t.t
t.t
db
db
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3876
0x87
(135)
1
0x13
(19)
187
35019 float
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3878
0x87
(135)
1
0x14
(20)
188
35020 float
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3880
0x87
(135)
1
0x15
(21)
189
35021 float
RWES
20
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3882
0x87
(135)
1
0x16
(22)
190
35022 uint
RWES
20
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3884
0x87
(135)
1
0x17
(23)
191
35023 uint
RWES
120
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3886
0x87
(135)
1
0x18
(24)
192
35024 uint
RWES
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3888
0x87
(135)
1
0x19
(25)
193
35025 float
RWES
0 to 9,999 seconds
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
139
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
t.dL
t.dL
Parameter Name
Description
Special Output (1)
Time Delay
If requested power
is 0.0% for longer
than the specified
Time Delay, the
compressor will
shut off.
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
0 to 9,999 seconds
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 3890
0x87
(135)
1
0x1A
(26)
----
35026 uint
RWES
High
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1360 1600
0x6E
(110)
1 to 2
1
137
10001 uint
RWES
FUn
SEt
Function Key
LEu
LEv
Function Key (1 to
2)
Active Level
The Function Key
will always power
up in the low state.
Pressing the Function Key will toggle
the selected action.
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1380 1620
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
140
Setup Page
Display
Fn
Fn
Parameter Name
Description
Function Key (1 to
2)
Action Function
Program the EZ Key
to trigger an action.
Functions respond
to a level state
change or an edge
level change.
Range
Default
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1364 1604
None
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Point (216)
Lr Limit Reset,
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1384 1624
0x6E
(110)
3 to 4
3
138
10003 uint
RWES
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
141
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
Fi
Fi
Function Key (1 to
2)
Function Instance
Select which instance the EZ
Key will affect. If
only one instance
is available, any
selection will affect it.
Range
Default
0 to 40
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1366 1606
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
1386 1626
0x96
(110)
3 to 4
4
139
10004
----
gLbL
SEt
Global Menu
C_F
C_F
AC.LF
AC.LF
r.typ
r.tyP
P.typ
P.tyP
gSE
gSE
Global
Display Units
Select which scale
to use for temperature.
F F (30)
C C (15)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1838 2308
0x67
(103)
1
5
110
3005 uint
RWES
Global
AC Line Frequency
Set the frequency
to the applied ac
line power source.
50 50 Hz (3)
60 60 Hz (4)
60 Hz
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
886 1006
0x6A
(106)
1
4
89
1034 uint
RWES
Global
Ramping Type
Time
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4414
0x7A
(122)
1
26 (38)
----
22038 uint
RWE
Global
Profile Type
Set the profile
startup to be based
on a set point or a
process value.
0x7A
(122)
1
8
----
22008 uint
RWE
Global
Guaranteed Soak
Enable
Enables the guaranteed soak deviation
function in profiles.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2530 4350
0x7A
(122)
1
6
----
22006 uint
RWE
2534 4354
Off
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
142
Setup Page
Display
gSd1
gSd1
gSd2
gSd2
Si.a
Si.a
Si.b
Si.b
poti
Poti
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Global
0.0 to 9,999.000F or 10.0F or Instance 1
Guaranteed Soak
units
units
Map 1 Map 2
Deviation 1
0.0 to 5,555.000C
6.0C
2532 4352
Set the value of
the deviation band
that will be used
in all profile step
types. The process
value must enter
the deviation band
before the step can
proceed.
0x7A
(122)
1
7
----
22007 float
RWE
Global
0.0 to 9,999.000F or 10.0F or Instance 1
Guaranteed Soak
units
units
Map 1 Map 2
Deviation 2
0.0 to 5,555.000C
6.0C
- - - - 4420
Set the value of
the deviation band
that will be used
in all profile step
types. The process
value must enter
the deviation band
before the step can
proceed.
0x7A
(122)
1
0x29
(41)
----
22041 float
RWE
Global
Source Instance A
Set the digital
source for Wait for
Event 1 in profile.
5 to 12
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4390
0x7A
(122)
1
0x1A
(26)
----
22060 uint
RWES
Global
5 to 12
Source Instance B
Set the digital
source for Wait for
Event 2 in profile.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4392
0x7A
(122)
1
0x1B
(27)
----
22061 uint
RWES
Global
0 to 9999 seconds
Power Off Time
If profile is running
and power is lost,
profile will resume
where it left off
provided time set
has not expired
prior to power restoration.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4484
0x7A
(122)
1
0x49
(73)
----
22073 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
143
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
SFn.E
SFn.E
Si.E
Si.E
SFn.F
SFn.F
Si.F
Si.F
sutb
Svtb
C.LEd
C.LEd
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Global
Source Function E
Set the source for
profile wait.
ai Analog Input
Global
Source Instance E
Set the instance
of the function selected above.
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Analog
Input
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4450
0x7A
(122)
1
0x38
(56)
- - - - 22056 uint
RWES
1 to 6
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4458
0x7A
(122)
1
0x3C
(60)
- - - - 22060 unsigned
8-bits
RWES
Global
Source Function F
Set the source for
profile wait.
ai Analog Input
Analog
Input
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4452
0x7A
(122)
1
0x39
(57)
- - - - 22057 uint
RWES
Global
Source Instance F
Set the instance
of the function selected above.
1 to 6
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 4460
0x7A
(122)
1
0x3D
(61)
- - - - 22061 unsigned
8-bits
RWES
----
----
- - - - float
RWE
0x6A
(103)
1
0x0E
(14)
----
3014 uint
RWES
(142)
(142)
Global
-2 to 2 %
Synchronized Variable Time Base
Used to acquire
tighter accuracy
when running a
profile. A setting
of +0.01 would
equate to approximately +9 seconds/day (faster)
where a setting of
-0.01 would equate
to approximately
-9 seconds/day
(slower).
0.00
Global
Communications
LED Action
Turns comms LED on
or off for selected
comms ports.
both
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1856 2326
(1189)
144
Setup Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
2onE
Zone
Chan
Chan
d.prs
d.PrS
d.ti
d.ti
USr.S
USr.S
USr.r
USr.r
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Global
Zone
Turns Zone LED on
or off based on selection.
On
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2350
0x6A
(103)
1
0x1A
(26)
----
3026 uint
RWES
Global
Channel
Turns Channel LED
on or off based on
selection.
On
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2352
0x6A
(103)
1
0x1B
(27)
----
3027 uint
RWES
Global
1 to 10
Display Pairs
Defines the number
of Display Pairs.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2354
0x6A
(103)
1
0x1C
(28)
----
3028 uint
RWES
Global
Display Time
Time delay in toggling between Display Pairs.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2356
0x6A
(103)
1
0x1D
(29)
----
3029 uint
RWES
Global
SEt1 User Set 1
Save Settings As
(101)
Save all of this
SEt2 User Set 2
controller's settings (102)
to the selected
nonE None (61)
set.
None
Instance 1 0x(101)
1
Map 1 Map 2
26
26 0xE (14)
Global
FCty Factory (31)
Restore Settings
nonE None (61)
From
SEt1 User Set 1
Replace all of this (101)
controller's settings SEt2 User Set 2
with another set.
(102)
None
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
24
24
Modbus
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2492 2972
0 to 60
118
1014
uint
RWE
0x65
(101)
1
0xD
(13)
117
1013
uint
RWE
0x96
(150)
1
7
----
Co
SEt
Communications Menu
PCoL
PCoL
Communications 1
Protocol
Set the protocol of
this controller to
the protocol that
this network is using.
od Modbus RTU
(1057)
17009 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
145
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Standard Bus
Ad.S
Ad.S
Communications 1
1 to 16
Standard Bus Address
Set the network
address of this controller. Each device
on the network
must have a unique
address.
The Zone Display on
the front panel will
display this number.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2480 2960
0x96
(150)
1
1
----
17001 uint
RWE
Communications (1 1 to 247
or 2)
Modbus Address
Set the network
address of this controller. Each device
on the network
must have a unique
address.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2482 2962
0x96
(150)
1 to 2
2
----
17007 uint
RWE
Communications (1
or 2)
Baud Rate
Set the speed of
this controller's
communications to
match the speed of
the Modbus serial
network.
9,600
0x96
(150)
1 to 2
3
----
17002 uint
RWE
Communications (1
or 2)
Parity
Set the parity of
this controller to
match the parity of
the Modbus serial
network.
0x96
(150)
1 to 2
4
----
17003 uint
RWE
Modbus RTU
Ad.
Ad.M
bAUd
bAUd
PAr
PAr
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2500 2980
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2484 2964
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2504 2984
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2486 2966
None
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2506 2986
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
146
Setup Page
Display
C_f
C_F
Parameter Name
Description
Communications (1
or 2)
Display Units
Select whether this
communications
channel will display
in Celsius or Fahrenheit.
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
f Fahrenheit (30)
C Celsius (15)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2490 2970
0x96
(150)
1
6
----
17050 uint
RWE
Lohi Low-High
Low-High
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2488 2968
0x96
(150)
1 to 2
5
----
17043 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17059 uint
RWE
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2494 2974
0x96
(150)
1
8
198
17051 uint
RWE
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
5020 8950
----
----
Note:
Applies to Modbus
only.
.hL
M.hL
ap
Map
nU.S
nV.S
no display
Communications (1
or 2)
Modbus Word Order
Select the word
order of the two
16-bit words in the
floating-point values.
(1331)
hiLo High-Low
(1330)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2508 2988
Communications (1 1 to 2
or 2)
Data Map
If set to 1 the control will use PM legacy mapping. If set
to 2 the control will
use new mapping to
accommodate new
functions.
1 if 9th
digit
of part
number
is a D or
1 otherwise, 2.
Communications (1
or 2)
Non-Volatile Save
If set to Yes all
values written to
the control will be
saved in EEPROM.
The EEPROM allows
for approximately
one million writes.
Yes
Communications (1
or 2)
Tick
Value increases at
1mS rate.
0 to 4,294,967,295
----
16006 unsigned
32-bit
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
147
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
DeviceNet
Ad.d
Ad.d
bAUd
bAUd
FC.E
FC.E
ao.nb
Ao.nb
ai.nb
Ai.nb
C_F
C_F
nU.S
nU.S
Communications (2)
DeviceNet Node
Address
Set the DeviceNet
address for this
gateway.
0 to 63
63
----
----
----
17052
----
Communications (2)
DeviceNet Baud
Rate
Set the DeviceNet
speed for this gateway's communications to match the
speed of the serial
network.
125
----
----
----
17053
----
Communications (2)
DeviceNet Quick
Connect Enable
Allows for immediate communication
with the scanner
upon power up.
no No (59)
yES Yes (106)
No
----
----
----
17054
----
Communications (2) 1 to 20
CIP Implicit Assembly Output Member
Quantity
20
----
----
----
24009
----
Communications (2) 1 to 20
CIP Implicit Assembly Input Member
Quantity
20
----
----
----
24010
----
Communications (2)
Display Units
Select which scale
to use for temperature passed over
communications
port 2.
F F (30)
C C (15)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2990
0x96
(150)
2
6
199
17050 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Non-volatile Save
If set to Yes all
values written to
the control will be
saved in EEPROM.
The EEPROM allows
for approximately
one million writes.
No
Instance 2 96 (150)
Map 1 Map 2
2
2514 2994
8
198
17051 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
148
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
J.ad
J.Ad
J.bAU
J.bAu
d.En
d.En
tEds
tEds
C_F
C_F
ap
Map
Communications (2)
J1939 Device Address
Set the Device address.
0 to 255
249
----
----
----
94001 unsigned
8-bits
RWE
Communications (2)
J1939 Baud Rate
Set the Digital Input
Bus communications
speed.
250
----
----
----
94002 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
J1939 Device Enable
Enables the device
for communication.
no No (59)
yES Yes (106)
Yes
----
----
----
94003 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Transducer Electronic Data Sheet
Contains sensor
technical characteristics when manufactured.
no No (59)
yES Yes (106)
Yes
----
----
----
94004 float
R
Communications (2)
J1939 Display Units
Select which scale
to use for temperature passed over
communications
port 2.
C C (15)
F F (30)
nonE None (61)
----
----
----
17050 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17059 uint
RWE
(1364)
Communications (2) 1 to 2
Data Map
If set to 1 the control will use legacy
Modbus mapping. If
set to 2, the control
will use new Modbus
mapping to accommodate new functions.
Not used with J1939.
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
149
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
nU.S
nU.S
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
No
----
----
----
- - - - uint
RWE
126
----
----
----
17060
----
Communications (2)
Profibus Address
Lock
When set to yes will
not allow address
to be changed using
software. Can be
changed from front
panel.
no No (59)
yES Yes (106)
No
----
----
----
17061
----
Communications
Profibus DP Status
Current Profibus
status.
----
----
----
----
17062 uint
R
Communications (2)
Display Units
Select which scale
to use for temperature passed over
communications
port 2.
F F (30)
C C (15)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2990
0x96
(150)
2
6
199
17050 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Non-volatile Save
If set to Yes all
values written to
the control will be
saved in EEPROM.
The EEPROM allows
for approximately
one million writes.
No
Instance 2 96 (150)
Map 1 Map 2
2
2514 2994
8
198
17051 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Non-volatile Save
If set to Yes all
values written to
the control will be
saved in EEPROM.
The EEPROM allows
for approximately
one million writes.
Profibus DP
P.Add
P.Add
a.Loc
A.Loc
stat
Stat
C_F
C_F
nU.S
nU.S
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
150
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
.hL
M.hL
iP.
iP.M
Communications (2)
Modbus Word Order
Select the word
order of the two
16-bit words in the
floating-point values.
Lohi Low-High
Communications (2)
IP Address Mode
Select DHCP to let a
DHCP server assign
an address to this
module.
Low-High
(1331)
hiLo High-Low
(1330)
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2488 2968
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
2508 2988
----
0x96
(150)
1 to 2
5
----
17043 uint
RWE
----
----
17012 uint
RWE
(1284)
Note:
When changing IP address, the control power must be cycled for the new address to take effect.
iP.F1
ip.F1
iP.F2
ip.F2
iP.F3
ip.F3
169
----
----
----
17014 uint
RWE
254
----
----
----
17015 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17016 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
151
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
iP.F4
ip.F4
iP.S1
ip.S1
iP.S2
ip.S2
iP.S3
ip.S3
iP.S4
ip.S4
iP.S5
ip.S5
iP.S6
ip.S6
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
----
----
----
17017 uint
RWE
255
----
----
----
17020 uint
RWE
255
----
----
----
17021 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17022 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17023 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17024 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17025 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
152
Setup Page
Display
iP.g1
ip.g1
iP.g2
ip.g2
iP.g3
ip.g3
iP.g4
ip.g4
iP.g5
ip.g5
iP.g6
ip.g6
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
----
----
----
17026 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17027 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17028 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17029 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17030 uint
RWE
----
----
----
17031 uint
RWE
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
153
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Setup Page
Display
b.E
Mb.E
EiP.E
EiP.E
ao.nb
Ao.nb
ai.nb
Ai.nb
C_F
C_F
nU.S
nV.S
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
Communications (2)
Modbus TCP Enable
Activate Modbus
TCP.
Yes
----
----
----
17041 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
EtherNet/IP Enable
Activate Ethernet/
IP.
Yes
----
----
----
17042 uint
RWE
Communications (2) 1 to 20
EtherNet/IP Output Assembly
When using EtherNet/IP set the CIP
Implicit Assembly
Output Member
Quantity
20
----
----
----
24009 uint
RWE
Communications (2) 1 to 20
EtherNet/IP Input
Assembly
When using EtherNet/IP set the CIP
Implicit Assembly
Input Member Quantity
20
----
----
----
24010 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Display Units
Select which scale
to use for temperature passed over
communications
port 2.
F F (30)
C C (15)
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
- - - - 2990
0x96
(150)
2
6
199
17050 uint
RWE
Communications (2)
Non-volatile Save
If set to Yes all
values written to
the control will be
saved in EEPROM.
The EEPROM allows
for approximately
one million writes.
No
Instance 2 96 (150)
Map 1 Map 2
2
2514 2994
8
198
17051 uint
RWE
Note:
When changing IP address, the control power must be cycled for the new address to take effect.
* These parameters/prompts are available in these menus with firmware revisions 11.0 and above.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
154
Setup Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
CIP Data
Modbus
Class
Pro- Param- Type
Relative Ad- Instance fibus eter
and
dress
Attribute Index
ID
Access
hex (dec)
**
rtC
SEt
Real Time Clock Menu
hoUr
hoUr
in
Min
do
doW
0 to 23
36003 uint
RW
0 to 59
36004 uint
RW
36002 uint
RW
(1561)
thUr Thursday
(1562)
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
155
Cha pte r 6 Se tu p Pa g e
Profile Setup
First, consider some foundational profile setup features that once configured, will apply to
all configured profiles. The screen shot below (EZ-ZONE Configurator software) graphically
shows the settings (shaded green)that will apply to all profiles; e.g., if Guaranteed Soak is
not enabled here this feature will not be available in any individual profile configuration.
Some of those features that apply to all profiles are listed below with a brief description of
their function.
- Ramping Type (Time or
Rate) which changes the
profile set point based
on a set interval of
time or set rate.
- Profile Type (Set Point
or Process) determines
whether a step (any
step changing the set
point) of a profile will
begin by using the process value (Process) or
the last closed-loop set
point (Set Point).
- Guaranteed Soak Enable, when set to on
makes this feature available in all profiles. If
Guaranteed Soak Enable
is on, use Guaranteed
Soak Deviation 1 to 2 to set the value for the corresponding loop. Set the deviation or band
above or below the working set point where this condition must be met before the profile
can proceed.
Note:
Changes made to profile parameters in the Profiling Pages will be saved and take effect
on the next pass through the step. Changes made in the Profile Status page effect the current step being executed and do not update the step setting in the profiling page. Changing profiles should only be changed by knowledgeable personnel and with caution.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
156
Once these global profile features are configured, the next step will require navigation to
the Profiling Page. Here, each desired ramp and soak profile will be configured.
To navigate to the Profile Page from the front panel, follow the steps below:
1. From the Home Page, press and hold the Advance Key for approximately five seconds.
The profile prompt prof will appear in the lower display and the profile number (e.g.
p1) appears in the upper display.
2. Press the Up or Down key to change to another profile (1 to 4).
3. Press the Advance Key to move to the selected profiles first step.
4. Press the Up or Down keys to move through and select the step type.
5. Press the Advance Key to move through the selected step settings.
6. Press the Up or Down keys to change the steps settings.
7. Press the Infinity Key at any time to return to the step number prompt.
8. Press the Infinity Key again to return to the profile number prompt.
9. From any point press and hold the Infinity Key for two seconds to return to the Home
Page.
If using EZ-ZONE Configurator software, simply click on the plus sign next to Profiles in the
left hand column, as
shown in the screen
shot below.
Notice in the screen
shot to the right some
fields or parameters
are not selectable
(grayed out) based on
the Step Type that is
selected.
Starting a Profile
There are several
ways to start a profile.
Some of the examples
that follow requires
that certain optional
hardware be available on the control. If
you are uncertain as
to how your control is
equipped, compare the
part number of your
control to the "Ordering Information" page
found in the Appendix
of this Users Guide.
Three ways to start a profile:
- Function Key, Digital Input or Profile Request
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
157
158
3. Press the Advance Key to enter this menu. The upper display will show 1 and the lower
display will show p.str.
4. Press the Up or Down keys to select the Profile or Step to start. In this example select 1.
5. Press the Advance Key to select the Profile Action Request. The upper display will show
nonE and the lower display will show p.aCr.
6. Press the Up or Down keys to select the Profile start. The upper display will show
prof and the lower display will show p.aCr.
Note:
As soon as the Green Advance Key is pressed (step 7 below) the designated Profile or
Step (as determined in step 4 above) will start.
7. Press the Advance Key to select whether Event 1 will be on or off. The upper display
will show off and the lower display will show Ent1.
Note:
This setting will temporally override the profile configuration.
8. Press the Up or Down keys to select whether Event 1 will be on or off. This will immediately drive the Event to the specified state regardless of the Profile configuration.
9. Press the Advance Key to select whether Event 2 will be on or off. The upper display
will show off and the lower display will show Ent2.
10. Press the Up or Down keys to select whether Event 2 will be on or off. This will immediately drive the Event to the specified state regardless of the Profile configuration.
Note:
The event state will be as left when the profile ended and may be toggled at the profile
status menu.
11. Press the Advance Key to see the current Jump Count. The upper display will show 0
and the lower display will show JC.
12. Return to the Home Page by pressing and holding the Infinity Key for approximately
three seconds.
159
Profiling Parameters
p1
prof
Profile (1 to 4)
1
P1 Profile [1 to 4] Step (1 to 40)
s.typ Step Type
t.SP1 Target Set Point Loop 1
t.SP2 Target Set Point Loop 2
hoUr Hours
in Minutes
SEC Seconds
ratE Rate
.pi Wait For Process Instance
.P1 Wait For Process 1
.E1 Wait For Event 1
E.2 Wait for Event 2
do Day of Week
Js Jump Step
JC Jump Count
End End Type
Ent1 Event 1
Ent2 Event 2
160
Profiling Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative
Address
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
----
----
----
----
P1
prof
Profiling Menu
p1
p4
1 to 10 [profile 1]
to Profile [1 to 4] Step
Select a step to edit or view. 11 to 20 [profile 2]
21 to 30 [profile 3]
31 to 40 [profile 4]
S.typ
S.typ
Step Type
Select a step type.
Note:
t.SP1
t.SP1
Unused
(50)
(144)
JL Jump (116)
End End (27)
CLoC Wait For Time
(1543)
ti Time (143)
ratE Rate (81)
-1,999.000 to
9,999.000F or
units
-1,128 to
5,537.000C
Note:
Some values will be rounded off to fit in the four-character display. Full values can be read with other interfaces.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
161
Profiling Page
Display
t.SP2
t.SP2
hoUr
hoUr
in
Min
SEC
SEC
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
-1,999.000 to
Step Type Parameters
9,999.000F or
Target Set Point Loop 2
units
When Step Type is Time enter the closed loop set point -1,128 to
for loop 2 to ramp to for this 5,537.000C
step.
0 to 9999
Modbus
Relative
Address
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
0 to 59
Step Type Parameters
Minutes
When Step Type is Time,
Soak, or Wait For Time enter
Minutes (plus Hours and Seconds) for this step.
0 to 59
Step Type Parameters
Seconds
When Step Type is Time,
Soak, or Wait For Time enter
Seconds (plus Hours and Minutes) for this step.
Note:
Some values will be rounded off to fit in the four-character display. Full values can be read with other interfaces.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
162
Profiling Page
Display
ratE
rAtE
.Pi
W.Pi
.P1
W.P1
Parameter Name
Description
Range
Default
Modbus
Relative
Address
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
0 to 9,999.000F or 0.0
Step Type Parameters
units per minute
Rate
0
to 5,555.000C per
When Step Type is Rate, enminute
ter the rate for ramping in
degrees or units per minute.
1 or 2
Step Type Parameters
Wait For Process Instance
When Step Type is Wait for
Process or Wait For Both,
enter which analog input
specified by Wait For Process
1 must be met before proceeding in profile.
-1,999.000 to
Step Type Parameters
9,999.000F or
Wait For Process 1
units
When Step Type is Wait for
-1,128.000
to
Process or Wait For Both,
5,537.000C
enter wait for process value
on analog
input specified by Wait For
Process Instance before proceeding in profile.
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, Map 2
equals +100)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, Map 2
equals +100)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, Map 2
equals +100)
Note:
Some values will be rounded off to fit in the four-character display. Full values can be read with other interfaces.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
163
Profiling Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
E.1
WE.1
Range
Default
Off
Off
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Note:
do
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Offset to
next instance (Map
1 equals
+50, Map 2
equals +100)
Note:
E.2
Modbus
Relative
Address
thUr Thursday
(1562)
164
Profiling Page
Display
JS
JS
JC
JC
End
End
Ent1
Ent1
Parameter Name
Description
Step Type Parameters
Jump Step
When Step Type is Jump,
this specifies which step to
jump back to. Jump Step
must be a lower step number than the current step
number.
Range
Default
1 to 40
Modbus
Relative
Address
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
0 to 9,999
Step Type Parameters
Jump Count
When Step Type is Jump,
this specifies the number of
jumps to repeat. A value
of 0 creates an infinite loop.
Loops can be nested four
deep.
Off
Off
Note:
Some values will be rounded off to fit in the four-character display. Full values can be read with other interfaces.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
165
Profiling Page
Display
Ent2
Ent2
Parameter Name
Description
Step Type Parameters
Event 2
When Step Type is not Unused Step, select whether
Event Output 1 or 2 is on or
off during this step.
Range
Modbus
Relative
Address
Default
Off
CIP
Class
Instance
Attribute
hex (dec)
Parameter
ID
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Note:
Some values will be rounded off to fit in the four-character display. Full values can be read with other interfaces.
** R: Read, W: Write, E: EEPROM, S: User Set
Display
UStP
UStP
ti
ti
rAtE
rAtE
SoAH
SoAh
CLoC
CLoC
Step Types
Unused Step
This is an empty step that can be used to plan for future steps
to be inserted or temporarily deactivate a step in a profile.
Change step type back when the step should be active again.
Step Types
Time
If Ramping Type found in the Global Menu of the Setup Page
is set for Time, the control loop will follow set point over the
specified time. If two loops of control are present then they will
both follow independent set points over the specified time. The
state of up to 2 event outputs may be set or maintained.
Step Types
Rate
If Ramping Type found in the Global Menu of the Setup Page is
set for Rate, specify the rate of change in degrees or units per
minute. The state of up to 2 event outputs may be set or maintained.
Step Types
Soak
A Soak Step maintains the last Target Set Points for the designated time. The state of up to 2 event outputs may be set or
maintained.
Step Types
Wait For Time
A Wait for Time Step is available with the real-time calendar
clock feature. This allows the program to wait for a specified
day and time before proceeding to the next step. Used to have
the profile execute steps everyday or only weekdays. The state
of up to 2 event outputs may be set or maintained.
166
----
Display
.E
W.E
.pr
W.Pr
.bo
W.bo
JL
JL
Step Types
Wait For Event
A Wait for Event Step will wait for the two Wait for Event states
(1 to 2) to match the specified state. The state of up to 2 event
outputs may be set or maintained.
Step Types
Wait For Process
A Wait for Process Step will wait for Process Value 1 or 2 to
match the Wait for Process Value. The state of up to 2 event
outputs may be set or maintained.
Step Types
Wait For Both
A Wait For Process and Event Step will wait for Process Value 1
or 2 to match the Wait for Process 1 value, and/or the two Wait
Event states to match the specified state. The state of up to 2
event outputs may be set or maintained.
End
End
Step Types
End
An End Step will end the profile and set the control modes and
set points to match the End Type. The state of up to 2 event
outputs may be set or maintained. The event outputs will not
be set off unless specifically stated in this step. If a profile does
not have an End Step, the profile continues until step 40, then
stops and maintains the last set points and control modes.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
167
CUSt
ULoC
1
CUSt Custom Setup (1 to 20)
par Parameter
iid Instance ID
LoC
diAg
Pn Part Number
rEu Software Revision
S.bLd Software Build Number
Sn Serial Number
dAtE Date of Manufacture
ip.aC IP Actual Address Mode
ip.a1 IP Actual Address Part 1
ip.a2 IP Actual Address Part 2
168
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Part
Part
Part
Part
3
4
5
6
CAL
FCty Calibration Menu
1
CaL Calibration (1 to 2)
u Electrical Measurement
ELi.o Electrical Input Offset
ELi.S Electrical Input Slope
ELo.o Electrical Output Offset
ELo.s Electrical Output Slope
Pn Part Number
CodE Code
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
169
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Factory Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Cust
fcty
Custom
par
Par
Custom
Parameter 1 to
20
nonE None
See:
L.hy Limit Hysteresis
Home
Lh.S High Limit Set Point
Page
LL.S Low Limit Set Point
Select the param- CU.r Load Current RMS
eters that will ap- Pro Process
pear in the Home i.CA Calibration Offset
C_F Display Units
Page.
USr.r Replace Settings From
A.Lo Low Set Point
The Parameter 1
A.hi High Set Point
value will appear A.hy Hysteresis
in the upper disCUSt Custom Menu
play of the Home StPt Set Point
AC.pu Active Process Value
Page. It cannot
AC.SP Active Set Point
be changed with
op Manual Power
the Up and Down AUt Autotune
Keys in the Home C. Control Mode
h.Pr Heat Power
Page.
C.Pr Cool Power
ti Time Integral
The Parameter
td Time Derivative
2 value will apdb Dead Band
pear in the lower h.Pb Heat Proportional
Band
display in the
Home Page. It can h.hy On/Off Heat Hysteresis
be changed with
C.Pb Cool Proportional
the Up and Down
Band
C.hy On/Off Cool HysterKeys, if the paesis
rameter is a writr.rt Ramp Rate
able one.
t.tUn TRU-TUNE+ Enable
idLE Idle Set Point
Scroll through the P.Str Profile Start
other Home Page P.ACr Profile Action Request
Stp Current Step
parameters with
s.typ Step Type
the Advance Key
t.sp1 Target Set Point Loop
1
.
t.sp2 Target Set Point Loop
2
Note:
hoUr Hours
Display Pairs afin Minutes
fect the pairing
SEC Seconds
of custom pagSd1 Guaranteed Soak
Deviation 1
rameters on the
gSd2 Guaranteed Soak
Home page. For
Deviation 2
more information Ent1 Event 1
on Display Pairs
Ent2 Event 2
JC Jump Count Remainsee the section
ing
in this guide enCUSt Custom Menu
----
- - - - - - - - 14005 uint
RWES
titled "Modifying
the Display Pairs".
170
Factory Page
Display
iid
iid
Parameter Name
Description
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Custom (1 to 20) 1 to 4
Instance ID
Select which
instance of the
parameter will
be selected.
Data
Type
and
Access
**
----
----
- - - - 14003 uint
RWES
LoC
FCty
Lock Menu
LoC.o
LoC.o
LoC.P
LoC.P
pas.E
LoC.P
rLoC
rLoC
Security Setting
Operations Page
Change the security level of
the Operations
Page.
1 to 3
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1832
2302
0x67
(103)
1
2
- - - - 3002
uint
RWE
Security Setting
Profiling Page
Change the
security level
of the Profiling
Page.
1 to 3
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1844
2314
0x67
(103)
1
8
- - - - 3008
uint
RWE
Security Setting
Password Enable
Set to On to
require a password for menu
changes.
off Off
on On
Off
----
----
- - - - 3009
uint
RWE
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1848
2318
0x67
(103)
1
0x0A
(10)
- - - - 3010
uint
RWE
Security Setting
1 to 5
Read Lock
Set the read security clearance
level. The user
can access the
selected level and
all lower levels.
If the Set Lockout Security level is higher than
the Read Lockout Security, the
Read Lockout
Security level
takes priority.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
171
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Factory Page
Display
SLoC
SLoC
LoC.L
LoC.L
roLL
roLL
pas.u
PAS.u
Parameter Name
Description
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Data
Type
and
Access
**
Security Setting
0 to 5
Write Security
Set the write security clearance
level. The user
can access the
selected level
and all lower
levels.
If the Set Lockout
Security level is
higher than the
Read Lockout Security, the Read
Lockout Security
level takes priority.
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
1844
2314
0x67
(103)
1
0x0B
(11)
- - - - 3011
uint
RWE
Security Setting
Locked Access
Level
Determines user
level menu visibility when
Password Enable
is set to on. See
Features section
under Password
Security.
1 to 5
----
----
- - - - 3016
uint
RWE
Security Setting
Rolling Password
When power is
cycled a new
Public Key will
be displayed and
User Password
changes.
off Off
on On
Off
----
----
- - - - 3019
uint
RWE
Security Setting
User Password
Used to acquire
access to menus
made available
through the
Locked Access
Level setting.
10 to 999
63
----
----
- - - - 3017
uint
RWE
172
Factory Page
Display
pas.a
PAS.A
Parameter Name
Description
Security Setting
Administrator
Password
Used to acquire
full access to all
menus including disabling or
changing passwords.
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
10 to 999
Data
Type
and
Access
**
156
----
----
- - - - 3018
uint
RWE
----
----
- - - - 3020
uint
R
----
----
- - - - 3022
int
RW
ULoC
FCty
Unlock Menu
CodE
CodE
pass
PASS
Security Setting
Public Key
If Rolling Password turned
on, generates a
random number
when power is
cycled. If Rolling Password
is off fixed
number will be
displayed. The
key can be used
to gain access
when password
is not known.
Customer Specific
Security Setting
-1999 to 9999
Password
Enter the User
or Administrator
password to gain
access. After
valid password
is supplied exit
this menu and
re-enter the
Security Menu
via the Factory
Page.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
173
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Factory Page
Display
Parameter Name
Description
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Data
Type
and
Access
**
diag
FCty
Diagnostics Menu
Pn
Pn
rEu
rEu
S.bLd
S.bLd
Sn
Sn
dAtE
dAtE
Diagnostics
Part Number
Display this
controller's part
number.
----
----
0x65
(101)
1
9
115
1009
string
R
Diagnostics
1 to 10
Software Revision
Display this
controller's firmware revision
number.
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
4
4
0x65
(101)
1
3
116
1003
string
R
Diagnostics
Software Build
Number
Display the
firmware build
number.
0 to 2,147,483,647
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
8
8
0x65
(101)
1
5
---
1005
dint
R
Diagnostics
Serial Number
Display the serial number.
0 to 2,147,483,647
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
12
12
0x65
(101)
1
0x20
(32)
---
1032
string
R
Diagnostics
Date of Manufacture
Display the date
code (YYWW).
Where YY = year
and WW= week.
0 to 2,147,483,647
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
14
14
0x65
(101)
1
8
---
1008
dint
R
0 to 2,147,483,647
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
0
0
0x65
(101)
1
1
---
1001
dint
R
0 to 2,147,483,647
----
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
2
2
0x65
(101)
1
2
---
1002
dint
R
No Dis- Diagnostics
Hardware ID
play
15 characters
Display the
Hardware ID.
No Dis- Diagnostics
Firmware ID
play
Display the
Firmware ID.
174
Factory Page
Display
iP.aC
iP.AC
iP.A1
ip.A1
Parameter Name
Description
Diagnostics
IP Address Mode
Actual address
mode (DHCP or
Fixed).
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Data
Type
and
Access
**
DHCP
----
----
- - - - 17038 R
169
----
----
- - - - 17044 R
254
----
----
- - - - 17045 R
(1284)
Diagnostics
0 to 255
IP Actual Address
Part 1
Actual IP address
of this module.
Note:
Although it appears as if this
can be changed
here this is a read
only parameter.
Go to Setup Page
and then the Com
Menu to change.
iP.A2
ip.A2
Diagnostics
0 to 255
IP Actual Address
Part 2
Actual IP address
of this module.
Note:
Although it appears as if this
can be changed
here this is a read
only parameter.
Go to Setup Page
and then the Com
Menu to change.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
175
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Factory Page
Parameter Name
Description
Display
iP.A3
ip.A3
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
Diagnostics
0 to 255
IP Actual Address
Part 3
Actual IP address
of this module.
Data
Type
and
Access
**
----
----
- - - - 17046 R
----
----
- - - - 17047 R
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
400
400
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x15
(21)
Note:
Although it appears as if this
can be changed
here this is a read
only parameter.
Go to Setup Page
and then the Com
Menu to change.
iP.A4
ip.A4
Diagnostics
0 to 255
IP Actual Address
Part 4
Actual IP address
of this module.
Note:
Although it appears as if this
can be changed
here this is a read
only parameter.
Go to Setup Page
and then the Com
Menu to change.
CAL
FCty
Calibration Menu
u
Mv
Calibration (1
-3.4e38 to 3.4e38
to 2)
Electrical Measurement
Read the raw
electrical value
for this input in
the units corresponding to
the Sensor Type
(Setup Page, Analog Input Menu)
setting.
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
480 490
---
4021
float
R
176
Factory Page
Display
ELi.o
ELi.o
ELi.S
ELi.S
ELo.o
ELo.o
ELo.S
ELo.S
Pn
Pn
Parameter Name
Description
Calibration (1
to 2)
Electrical Input
Offset
Change this value to calibrate
the low end of
the input range.
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
-1,999.000 to 9,999.000
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
378
378
0.0
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
458 468
Calibration (1
-1,999.000 to 9,999.000
to 2)
Electrical Input
Slope
Adjust this value
to calibrate the
slope of the input value.
1.0
Calibration (1
or 3)
Electrical Output Offset
Change this value to calibrate
the low end
of the output
range.
0.0
-1,999.000 to 9,999.000
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
380
380
Instance 2
Map 1 Map 2
460 470
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
728
848
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
808 928
Calibration (1
-1,999.000 to 9,999.000
or 3)
Electrical Output Slope
Adjust this value
to calibrate the
slope of the output value.
1.0
Calibration (1
to 3)
Part Number
Displays current setting for
control model
number.
Factory
fCty Factory
UsEr User
Instance 1
Map 1 Map 2
730
850
Instance 3
Map 1 Map 2
810 930
----
Data
Type
and
Access
**
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0x0A
(10)
---
4010
float
RWES
0x68
(104)
1 to 2
0xB
(11)
---
4011
float
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
5
---
18005 float
RWES
0x76
(118)
1 or 3
6
---
18006 float
RWES
----
---
----
uint
R
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
177
Cha pte r 8 F a c to r y Pa g e
Factory Page
Display
CodE
CodE
Parameter Name
Description
Calibration (1
to 3)
Public Key
Changes the
control to User
or back to original model number as shown on
the side of the
control.
CIP
Class
Modbus
Instance Pro- ParamDefault Relative Ad- Attri- fibus eter
dress
bute Index ID
hex
(dec)
Range
4999
----
----
---
----
Data
Type
and
Access
**
uint
RWES
ber
178
Chapter 9: Features
Changing PM Integrated Model Number to PM Express . . . . . . 181
Saving and Restoring Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Tuning the PID Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Autotune. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Manual Tuning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Autotuning with TRUTUNE+. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Calibration Offset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Filter Time Constant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Sensor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Sensor Backup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Set Point Minimum and Maximum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Scale High and Scale Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Range High and Range Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Receiving a Remote Set Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Ten Point Linearization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Duplex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
NO-ARC Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Retransmitting a Process Value or Set Point. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Cool Output Curve. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
179
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Alarms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Process and Deviation Alarms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Set Points. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Hysteresis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Latching. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Silencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Blocking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
180
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
PM _ _ _ _ _ - A A A A B A A
Package Size
No Change
Primary Function
C
R
B
T
J
N
E
S
Power Supply
1
2
3
4
Output 1
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Universal process
Universal process
Universal process
Universal process
None
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
Output 2
None
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Switched dc
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
None
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Switched dc
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
None
Switched dc (cannot use variable time base)
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
None
- Standard Bus EIA-485 always included - all models
Additional Options
B
Changes to Express
AA
AB
AC
AG
12
Custom Options
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
181
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Note:
As noted above, when switching from a PM Standard to a PM Express version, optional
hardware (even though installed) may no longer work. Also, all settings will be defaulted
to the selected model when switched.
Note:
After switching the model number to a PM Express this document will no longer apply to
the control. Click on the link that follows to acquire the latest version of the PM PID Express User's Guide. http://www.watlow.com/en/Resources-And-Support/Technical-Library/
User-Manuals
Once there, simply enter express in the "Keyword" field to find the appropriate document.
or Reset Key and the Advance Key together or using EZ-ZONE Configurator software.
2. Once there, use the Advance Key to navigate to the Part Number pn prompt. The upper
display will show user USEr indicating the user's selected model number is currently in
effect.
3. Push the Advance Key where the Public Key CodE prompt will appear in the lower display and the number 4999 in the upper display.
4. Using the up or down arrow keys enter 606 and push the Advance Key to execute the
change. The controller will reboot and the new controller model number is in effect. All
previous settings are lost and the controller must be reprogrammed for the application.
Be sure to label the controller with the new model number for future reference.
Note:
When switching from a PM Express back to the original model number all original optional
hardware will again be enabled for use (assuming all original hardware is still installed).
Also, when executing this step the control will be factory defaulted back to the original
model number (as shown on the side of the control) at zone address 1. This User's Guide
would once again apply to this control.
182
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
After you program the controller and verify proper operation, select Save Settings As Usr.s
(Setup Page, Global Menu) to save the settings into either of two files (sEt1 or sEt2) in the
control memory.
Note:
Saving the settings overwrites any previously saved collection of settings. Be sure to document all the controller settings.
If the settings in the controller are altered a user can return the controller to one of three
settings. If previously saved, sEt1 or sEt2 can be restored as well as the factory fCty
settings. Navigate to the Setup Page, Global Menu to find the Restore USr.r prompt. A digital input or the Function Key can also be configured to restore parameters.
Note:
When restoring factory defaults, I/O assemblies for Modbus, DeviceNet, Profibus and Ethernet along with the zone address will be overwritten when restoring factory defaults.
Autotune complete
Autotune begins
Time
A new feature in EZ-ZONE PM products will allow set point changes while the control is
autotuning, this includes while running a profile or ramping. When the auto tune is initially
started it will use the current set point and will disregard all set point changes until the tuning process is complete. Once complete, the controller will then use the new set point. This
is why it is a good idea to enter the active set point before initiating an autotune.
Autotuning calculates the optimum heating and/or cooling PID parameter settings based on
the system's response. Autotuning can be enabled whether or not TUNE-TUNE+ is enabled.
The PID settings generated by the autotune will be used until the autotune feature is rerun,
the PID values are manually adjusted or TRU-TUNE+ is enabled.
To initiate an autotune, set Autotune Request AUt (Operations Page, Loop Menu) to yEs.
You should not autotune while a profile is running. If the autotune cannot be completed in 60
minutes, the autotune will time-out and the original settings will take effect.
Depending on which loops are being tuned the lower display may flash tUn1 or tUn2 and
the set point while the autotuning is underway. The temperature must cross the Autotune Set
Point five times to complete the autotuning process. Once complete, the controller controls
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
183
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Manual Tuning
In some applications, the autotune process may not provide PID parameters for the process
characteristics you desire. If that is the case, you may want to tune the controller manually.
1. Apply power to the controller and establish a set point typically used in your process.
2. Go to the Operations Page, Loop Menu, and set Heat Proportional Band h.pb and/or Cool
Proportional Band C.pb to 5. Set Time Integral ti to 0. Set Time Derivative td to 0.
3. When the system stabilizes, watch the process value. If it fluctuates, increase the Heat
Proportional Band or Cool Proportional Band value in 3 to 5 increments until it stabilizes,
allowing time for the system to settle between adjustments.
4. When the process has stabilized, watch Heat Power h.pr or Cool Power C.pr (Operations Page, Monitor Menu). It should be stable 2%. At this point, the process temperature
should also be stable, but it will have stabilized before reaching the set point. The difference between the set point and actual process value can be eliminated with Integral.
5. Start with an Integral value of 6,000 and allow 10 minutes for the process temperature to
reach the set point. If it has not, reduce the setting by half and wait another 10 minutes.
Continue reducing the setting by half every 10 minutes until the process value equals the
set point. If the process becomes unstable, the Integral value is too small. Increase the
value until the process stabilizes.
6. Increase Derivative to 0.1. Then increase the set point by 11 to 17C. Monitor the systems approach to the set point. If the process value overshoots the set point, increase
Derivative to 0.2. Increase the set point by 11 to 17C and watch the approach to the
new set point. If you increase Derivative too much, the approach to the set point will
be very sluggish. Repeat as necessary until the system rises to the new set point without
overshoot or sluggishness.
For additional information about autotune and PID control, see related features in this chapter.
Once the Process Value has been at set point for a suitable period (about 30 minutes for a
fast process to roughly two hours for a slower process) and if no further tuning of the PID
parameters is desired or needed, TRUTUNE+ may be turned off. However, keeping the
controller in the adaptive mode allows it to automatically adjust to load changes and compensate for differing control characteristics at various set points for processes that are not
entirely linear.
Once the PID parameters have been set by the TRUTUNE+ adaptive algorithm, the process,
if shut down for any reason, can be restarted in the adaptive control mode. Turn TRUTUNE+
on or off with TRUTUNE+ Enable t.tUn (Setup Page, Loop Menu).
Use TRUTUNE+ Band tbnd (Setup Page, Loop Menu) to set the range above and below the
set point in which adaptive tuning will be active. Adjust this parameter only in the unlikely
event that the controller is unable to stabilize at the set point with TRUTUNE+ Band set to
auto (0). This may occur with very fast processes. In that case, set TRUTUNE+ Band to a
large value, such as 100.
Use TRUTUNE+ Gain t.gn (Setup Page, Loop Menu) to adjust the responsiveness of the adaptive tuning calculations. Six settings range from 1, with the most aggressive response and
most potential overshoot (highest gain), to 6, with the least aggressive response and least
potential for overshoot (lowest gain). The default setting, 3, is recommended for loops with
thermocouple feedback and moderate response and overshoot potential.
Before Tuning
Before autotuning, the controller hardware must be installed correctly, and these basic configuration parameters must be set:
Sensor Type sEn (Setup Page, Analog Input Menu), and scaling, if required;
Function fn (Setup Page, Output Menu) and scaling, if required.
Inputs
Calibration Offset
Calibration offset allows a device to compensate for an inaccurate sensor, lead resistance or
other factors that affect the input value. A positive offset increases the input value, and a
negative offset decreases the input value. The input offset value can be viewed or changed
with Calibration Offset i.Ca (Operations Page, Analog Input Menu).
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
185
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Calibration
Temperature
Before performing any calibration procedure, verify that the displayed readings are not
within published specifications by inputting a known value from a precision source to the
analog input. Next, subtract the
displayed value with the known
value and compare this differNegative Calibration Offset will
ence to the published accuracy
compensate for the difference
Temperature Reading
range specification for that type
between the Sensor Reading and
from Sensor
the Actual Temperature
of input.
Use of the Calibration Offset
i.Ca parameter found in the
Operations Page opEr, Analog
Input Menu ai shifts the readings across the entire displayed
Actual Process Temperature
range by the offset value. Use
this parameter to compensate
for sensor error or sensor placement error. Typically this value is
Time
set to zero.
186
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Note:
The user may only calibrate one sensor type. If the calibrator interferes with open thermocouple detection, set Sensor Type sEn in Setup Page sEt, Analog Input Menu ai to
millivolt u instead of Thermocouple tC to avoid interference between the calibrator
and open thermocouple detect circuit for the duration of the calibration process. Be sure
to set sensor type back to the thermocouple type utilized.
1. Disconnect the sensor from the controller.
2. Record the Calibration Offset i.Ca parameter value in the Operations Page opEr, Analog
Input Menu ai then set value to zero.
3. Wire the precision source to the appropriate controller input terminals to be calibrated.
Do not have any other wires connected to the input terminals. Please refer to the Install
and Wiring section of this manual for the appropriate connections.
4. Ensure the controller sensor type is programmed to the appropriate Sensor Type sEn to
be utilized in the Setup Page sEt, Analog Input Menu ai.
5. Enter Factory Page fCty, Calibration Menu CaL via front panel or EZ-ZONE Configurator
Software.
6. Select the Calibration CaL input instance to be calibrated. This corresponds to the analog
input to be calibrated.
7. Set Electrical Input Slope ELi.s to 1.000 and Electrical Input Offset ELi.o to 0.000 (this
will cancel any prior user calibration values)
8. Input a Precision Source Low value. Read Electrical Measurement value u of controller
via EZ-Configurator or RUI. This will be referred to as Electrical Measured Low. Record low
value ______________
9. Input a Precision Source High value.
10. Read Electrical Measurement value u of controller via EZ-Configurator or RUI. This will
be referred to as Electrical Measured High. Record high value ______________
11. Calculated Electrical Input Slope = (Precision High Precision Low) / (Electrical Measured High - Electrical Measured Low) Calculated Slope value ___________
12. Calculated Electrical Input Offset = Precision Low - (Electrical Input Slope * Measured
Low) Calculated Offset value ___________
13. Enter the calculated Electrical Input Slope ELi.s and Electrical Input Offset ELi.o into
the controller.
14. Exit calibration menu.
15. Validate calibration process by utilizing a calibrator to the analog input.
16. Enter calibration offset as recorded in step 2 if required to compensate for sensor error.
Setting Electrical Input Slope ELi.s to 1.000 and Electrical Input Offset ELI.o to 0.000, restores factory calibration as shipped from factory.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
187
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Temperature
Time
Time
Adjust the filter time interval with Filter Time fiL (Setup Page, Analog Input Menu). Example: With a filter value of 0.5 seconds, if the process input value instantly changes from 0 to 100
and remained at 100, the display will indicate 100 after five time constants of the filter value or
2.5 seconds.
Sensor Selection
You need to configure the controller to match the input device, which is normally a thermocouple, RTD or process transmitter.
Select the sensor type with Sensor Type SEn (Setup Page, Analog Input Menu).
Sensor Backup
Sensor backup maintains closed-loop control after an input failure by switching control to
input 2. The sensor backup feature is only available in an EZ-ZONE PM Integrated Limit or
Remote Set Point controller. Turn sensor backup on or off with Sensor Backup Enable S.ba
(Setup Page, Analog Input 1).
Note:
When Sensor Backup is enabled the Process Value function will automatically set itself to
Sensor Backup.
You can create a scale range representing other units for special applications. You can reverse scales from high values to low values for analog input signals that have a reversed action. For example, if 50 psi causes a 4 mA signal and 10 psi causes a 20 mA signal.
Scale low and high low values do not have to match the bounds of the measurement range.
These along with range low and high provide for process scaling and can include values not
measurable by the controller. Regardless of scaling values, the measured value will be constrained by the electrical measurements of the hardware. Select the low and high values
with Scale Low s.Lo and Scale High s.hi. Select the displayed range with Range Low r.Lo
and Range High r.hi (Setup Page, Analog Input Menu).
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
189
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Temperature
The linearization function allows a user to re-linearize a value read from an analog input.
There are 10 data points used to compensate for differences between the sensor value read
(input point) and the desired value (output
Input Point 10
point). Multiple data points enable compensa9
Reading from Sensor
8
Output Point 10
tion for non-linear differences between the
without Linearization
67
5
(Actual Value)
4
sensor readings and target process values over
3
Offset Zone
the thermal or process system operating
2
Input Point 1
range. Sensor reading differences can be
caused by sensor placement, tolerances, an
Reading from Sensor
with Linearization
inaccurate sensor or lead resistance.
(Displayed Value)
Output Point 1
No Offset
Outputs
Duplex
Certain systems require that a single process output, control both heating and cooling outputs. An EZ-ZONE PM controller with a process output can function as two separate outputs.
With a 4 to 20mA output the heating output will operate from 12 to 20mA (0 to +100 percent)
and the cooling output will operate from 12 to 4mA (0 to -100 percent).
In some cases this type of output is required by the device that the EZ-ZONE PM controls,
such as a three-way valve that opens one way with a 12 to 20mA signal and opens the other
way with a 4 to 12mA signal. This feature reduces the overall system cost by using a single
output to act as two outputs.
Outputs 1 and 3 can be ordered as process outputs. Select duplex dUpL as the Output Function fn (Setup Page, Output Menu). Set the output to volts voLt or milliamps a with Type
o.ty. Set the range of the process output with Scale Low S.Lo and Scale High s.hi.
NO-ARC Relay
A NO-ARC relay provides a significant improvement in the life of the output relay over conventional relays. Conventional mechanical relays have an expected life of 100,000 cycles at
the rated full-load current. The shorter life for conventional relays is due to the fact that
when contacts open while current is flowing metal degradation occurs. This action produces
unavoidable electrical arcing causing metal to transfer from one contact to the other. The
arcing conditions continue on each subsequent contact opening until over time the resistance
through the contacts increases causing the contacts to increase in temperature. Eventually,
the contacts will weld together and the relay remains in the on state.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
190
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
The Watlow NO-ARC relay is a hybrid relay. It uses a mechanical relay for the current load
and a triac (solid-state switch) to carry the turn-on and turn-off currents. NO-ARC relays
extend the life of the relay more than two million cycles at the rated full-load current.
Although a NO-ARC relay has significant life advantages, a few precautions must be followed
for acceptable usage:
Do not use:
Hybrid relays for limit contactors. A limit or safety device must provide a positive mechanical break on all hot legs simultaneously
DC loads with hybrid relays. The triacs used for arc suppression will turn off only with ac
line voltage
Hybrid switches to drive any inductive loads, such as relay coils, transformers or solenoids
Cycle times less than five seconds on hybrid switches
On loads that exceed 264V ac through relay
On loads that exceed 15 amperes load
On loads less than 100mA
NO-ARC relays in series with other NO-ARC relays
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
191
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
80
60
40
20
Linear
Curve A
Linear
Curve B
Curve 1
Curve 2
PID Calculation
Execute One of the Following Steps to Reset a Tripped Limit Prior to Firmware Release 11.0:
1. Push the Reset Key
2. Configure a digital input with the Action Function set to Limit Reset (navigate to the Setup
Page under the Digital I/O Menu).
3. Use a field bus protocol, i.e., Modbus, EtherNet/IP, etc...where a value of zero would
be written to the associated address (navigate to the Operations Page and look for Clear
Limit under the Limit Menu to find appropriate address).
4. Cycle the power to the controller.
RESET
192
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Execute One of the Following Steps to Reset a Tripped Limit with Firmware Release 11.0 and
above:
1. Push the Reset Key
2. Follow the steps below:
2a. Navigate to the Setup Page and then the Limit Menu
2b. Set Source Function A to the desired device that will reset the limit (Digital I/O or
Function Key)
2c. Define the Source Instance
3. Use a field bus protocol, i.e., Modbus, EtherNet/IP, etc...where a value of zero would
be written to the associated address (navigate to the Operations Page and look for Clear
Limit under the Limit Menu to find appropriate address).
4. Cycle the power to the controller.
RESET
Control Methods
Output Configuration
Each controller output can be configured as a heat output, a cool output, an alarm output
or deactivated. No dependency limitations have been placed on the available combinations.
The outputs can be configured in any combination. For instance, all three could be set to
cool.
Heat and cool outputs use the set point and Operations parameters to determine the output
value. All heat and cool outputs use the same set point value. Heat and cool each have their
own set of control parameters. All heat outputs use the same set of heat control parameters
and all cool outputs use the same set of cool output parameters.
Each alarm output has its own set of configuration parameters and set points, allowing independent operation.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
193
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Power
Temperature
Bumpless transfer will allow the controller to transfer to the manual mode using the last
power value calculated in the auto mode
if the process had stabilized at a 5
Actual Temperature
Set Point
percent output power level for the time
interval or 10 seconds, (whichever is
Sensor
Break
longer) prior to sensor failure, and that
power level is less than 75 percent.
Reverse Bumpless functionality will take 100%
Output Power
effect when the control is changed from
40%
Manual to Auto mode. The control will
Locks in
2 minutes
Output
preload the Manual Power value into the
0%
Power
Integral and Proportional Terms, which
Time
will allow for a bumpless transition. The
normal PID action will then take over to control the output to the Set Point value.
Note:
Reverse bumpless ignores the transition from Off to Auto.
Input Error Latching i.Er (Setup Page, Analog Input Menu) determines the controllers response once a valid input signal returns to the controller. If latching is on, then the controller will continue to indicate an input error until the error is cleared. To clear a latched
alarm, press the Advance Key then the Up Key . If latching is off, the controller will
automatically clear the input error and return to reading the temperature. If the controller was in the auto mode when the input error occurred, it will resume closed-loop control.
If the controller was in manual mode when the error occurred, the controller will remain in
open-loop control. The Manual Control Indicator Light % is on when the controller is operating in manual mode.
You can easily switch between modes if the Control Mode C. parameter is selected to appear in the Home Page.
To transfer to manual mode from auto mode:
1. Press the Advance Key until C. appears in the lower display. The upper display will
display aUto for auto mode.
2. Use the Up or Down keys to select an. The manual set point value will be recalled from the last manual operation.
To transfer to auto mode from manual mode:
1. Press the Advance Key until C. appears in the lower display. The upper display will
display an for manual mode.
2. Use the Up or Down keys to select aUto. The automatic set point value will be recalled from the last automatic operation.
Changes take effect after three seconds or immediately upon pressing either the Advance
Key or the Infinity Key .
On-Off Control
On-off control switches the output either full on or full off, depending on the input, set
point and hysteresis values. The hysteresis value indicates the amount the process value
must deviate from the set point to turn on the output. Increasing the value decreases the
number of times the output will cycle. Decreasing hysteresis improves controllability. With
hysteresis set to 0, the process value would stay closer to the set point, but the output
would switch on and off more frequently, and may result in the output chattering. On-off
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
194
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
control can be selected with Heat Algorithm h.ag or Cool Algorithm C.ag (Setup Page, Loop
Menu). On-off hysteresis can be set with On/Off Heat Hysteresis h.hy or On/Off Cool Hysteresis C.hy (Operations Page, Loop Menu).
Note:
Input Error Failure Mode faiL does not function in on-off control mode. The output
goes off.
On/Off System Cycles
Temperature
Temperature
Set Point
Process Temperature
Set Point
On/Off Hysteresis
The cooling action switches off when the process
temperature drops below the set point.
Time
Time
Temperature
Some processes need to maintain a temperature or process value closer to the set point than
on-off control can provide. Proportional control provides closer control by adjusting the
output when the temperature or process value is within a proportional band. When the value
is in the band, the controller adjusts the output based on how close the process value is to
the set point. The closer the process value is to the set point, the lower the output power.
This is similar to backing off on the gas pedal
Proportional Control
of a car as you approach a stop sign. It keeps
Overshoot
Set Point
the temperature or process value from swinging as widely as it would with simple on-off
control. However, when the system settles
Droop
Proportional Band
down, the temperature or process value
tends to droop short of the set point.
With proportional control, the output power
level equals the set point minus the process
value divided by proportional band times 100.
In an application with one output assigned
Time
to heating and another assigned to cooling,
each will have a separate proportional parameter. The heating parameter takes effect when
the process temperature is lower than the set point, and the cooling parameter takes effect
when the process temperature is higher than the set point.
Adjust the proportional band with Heat Proportional Band h.pb or Cool Proportional Band
C.pb (Operations Page, Loop Menu).
Reduced Overshoot
Temperature
Proportional Band
Time
Dead Band
In a PID application the dead bands above and below the set point can save an applications
energy and wear by maintaining process temperature within acceptable ranges.
Proportional action ceases when the process value is within the dead band. Integral action
continues to bring the process temperature to the set point. Using a positive dead band
value keeps the two systems from fighting each other.
Positive Dead Band
Temperature
Time
When the dead band value is zero, the heating output activates when the temperature
drops below the set point, and the cooling output switches on when the temperature exceeds the set point.
Temperature
Set Point
Time
196
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Temperature
Set Point
Time
50 percent output
10 ON, 0 OFF
3 ON, 3 OFF
66 percent output
6 ON, 3 OFF
The combination of variable time base output and a solid-state relay can inexpensively approach the effect of analog, phase-angle fired control. Select the AC Line Frequency AC.Lf
(Setup Page, Global Menu), 50 or 60 Hz.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
197
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Set Point
Temperature
Temperature
Set Point
degrees
per minute
Time
Time
Cascade Control
The PM (PM4/8/9) can be configured for Cascade control with enhanced firmware. Cascade
is used to optimize the performance of thermal systems with long lag times. It utilizes a control strategy in which one control loop provides the set point for another loop. See Chapter
10 for application examples.
Compressor Control
The PM control can be configured for Compressor control with two loops of control and
enhanced firmware. A typical use scenario for compressor control is for cooling and/or dehumidification. The application may have one or two loops of control which utilize the compressor to accomplish the cooling and/or dehumidification (negative power levels). Because
the compressor is a mechanical device, it is desirable to minimize unwanted starts and
stops. Either loop can attempt to start or stop the compressor, but this algorithm will make
the determination when it should or should not run. Because you may not turn the compressor off until the loop is in the heat or
% Power
100%
Heat
humidify region, the input values
(Source Function A and B) to the compressor algorithm must be loop power
2% Compressor
Off Power
2%
(+/- 100%).
0%
The compressor will turn on and off
0% Compressor
On Power
under the following conditions:
Loop 1
Cool -100%
Off - When Source A Value >= Input A
Time In Seconds
Turn Off
Compressor On Delay = 45 Seconds
On
On - When Source A Value <= Input A
Compressor
Off
Turn On
Compressor Off Delay = 20 Seconds
Loop 2
Off - When Source B Value >= Input B
Turn Off
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
198
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Differential Control
The PM can be configured for Differential Control with two inputs and enhanced firmware.
After configuring the appropriate inputs and their associated internal functions Differential
Control allows the PM to drive an output based on the difference between those analog inputs. See Chapter 10 for application examples.
Ratio Control
The PM control can be configured for Ratio control with two inputs and enhanced firmware,
especially useful in applications that mix materials. Ratio control is commonly used to ensure that two or more flows are kept at the same ratio even if the flows are changing. See
Chapter 10 for application examples.
Duplex Control
Certain systems require that a single process output, control both heating and cooling outputs. A PM control with a
process output can function
Fluid S a mple Cont a ine r
Input 1
Output 1
as two separate outputs.
hot water
temperature
With a 4 to 20mA output the
transmitter
heating output, for instance,
will operate from 12 to 20mA
(0 to +100%) and the cooling
outputs will operate from 12
cold water
to 4mA (0 to -100%). In some
cases this type of output is
required by the device, such as a three-way valve that opens one way with a 12 to 20mA
signal and opens the other way with a 4 to 12mA signal. This feature reduces the overall
system cost by using a single output to act as two outputs.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
199
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Timer Function
1. When Timer Enable ti.En is set to yes yEs and the timer is started (you define which key
combination this is), the controller will switch from Set Point C.sp1 to Closed Loop Timer
Set Point Ct.s1. If the timer is interrupted, the timer is terminated and the time remaining is reset to its initial value.
2. When Timer Start Method ti.st is set to:
a. Immediate id, the timer starts as soon as the counter is initiated. When Time Remaining t.r1 equals zero, the set point changes from Closed Loop Timer Set Point Ct.s1
back to Set Point C.SP1. A flashing colon 00:00 indicates that a countdown is in progress.
b. Ready Band rdy, the set point changes and when the temperature is within ready
band, the ready band indicator lights up and the countdown timer starts and continues as long as the temperature is within the ready band. When Time Remaining t.r1
equals zero, the set point changes from Closed Loop Timer Set Point Ct.s1 back to Set
Point C.sp1. A flashing colon 00:00 indicates that a countdown is in progress.
c. Ready Acknowledge rdya, the set point changes, and when the temperature is within
the ready band, the ready band indicator lights up. The user must then acknowledge
(you define which key combination for this) that the countdown timer should start and
continue as long as the temperature is within the ready band. When Time Remaining
t.r1 equals zero, the set point changes from Closed Loop Timer Set Point Ct.s1 back to
Set Point C.sp1. A flashing colon 00:00 indicates that a countdown is in progress.
d. Power Pr, the timer starts when the controller is turned on. When Time Remaining
t.r1 equals zero, the set point changes from Closed Loop Timer Set Point Ct.s1 back to
Set Point C.sp1. A flashing colon 00:00 indicates that a countdown is in progress.
3. In Setup Page, Output Menu, Output Function fn can be assigned as Timer Event Output
1 tE.o1, Timer Event Output 2 tE.o2 or Timer Event Output 3 tE.o3. Timer Event Output
1 is active during timing, Timer Event Output 2 is deactivated during timing and Timer
Event Output 3 produces a pulse at the end of the timing sequence. These signals may be
used to monitor timer activity. Process outputs may not be assigned to Timer Event Outputs.
4. The home display is customized in the Factory Page, Custom Menu. You may program the
display to alternate between display pairs. See display pairs in the Setup Page, Global
Menu. As an example, we could show the process temperature in the upper display and
have the lower display alternate between the countdown time remaining and the active
set point.
Note:
The timer feature is only available for control loop 1 of two-loop controllers. Time is
entered in hours, minutes and seconds. Countdown time will use the entered time but
display the time remaining in either hh:mm or mm:ss format, based on your settings. The
colon pulses in one-second intervals during a countdown, to indicate that timing is underway. Parameters that appear in the Home page have the number 1 at the end of the displayed parameter. As an example, hoUr in the Setup Page, Timer Menu will be displayed
as hoU1 in the Home Page.
200
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
201
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
11. Advance to Source Instance D and use the up arrow to make a selection below:
If Source Function A of previous step is set to None nonE:
1 Does not matter which number is here
si.d Source Instance D
If Source Function A of previous step is set to Digital I/O dio:
5 Select 5 to 12
si.d Source Instance D
If Source Function A of previous step is set to Function Key fUn:
1 EZ1 Key
2
EZ2 Key
6 Hold infinity key for 2 seconds
7 Infinity and Down arrow
8 Infinity and Up arrow
si.d Source Instance D
12. Advance to Time Remaining t.r, read only, display in hh:mm or mm:ss.
13. Advance to Ready Band State r.bs, read only, displayed as yes yEs or no no.
14. Advance to Ready Band rdy to enter the value for Ready Band using Up or Down arrow .
15. Advance to Time Format t.for to select the time format. Use the up arrow to make
selection below:
th Time Hours:Minutes
ts Time Minutes:Seconds
16. Advance to Countdown Time to enter hours, minutes and seconds using the Up or
Down arrow .
hoUr Hours, then Advance
in Minutes, then Advance
SEC Seconds
17. Advance to Closed Loop Timer Set Point Ct.SP to enter the temperature during counting using the Up or Down arrow .
18. Advance to Signal Time st to enter time in seconds for Timer Event Output 3 tE.o3 to
be active at end of countdown time.
19. Press and hold the Infinity or Reset key for more than 2 seconds to go to Home Page.
20. See programming custom home page in factory page, custom menu to change the display
parameters such as active process value, closed loop set point time, closed loop timer
set point and time remaining as appropriate for the application.
Alarms
Alarms are activated when the output level, process value or temperature leaves a defined
range. A user can configure how and when an alarm is triggered, what action it takes and
whether it turns off automatically when the alarm condition is over. Configure alarm outputs
in the Setup Page before setting alarm set points. Alarms do not have to be assigned to an
output. Alarms can be monitored and controlled through the front panel or by using software.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
202
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Set Points
The high set point defines the process value or temperature that will trigger a high side
alarm. The low set point defines the temperature that will trigger a low side alarm. For
deviation alarms, a negative set point represents a value below set point used by the control
loop. A positive set point represents a value above the set point used by the control loop.
View or change alarm set points with Low Set Point a.Lo and High Set Point a.hi (Operations
Page, Alarm Menu).
Hysteresis
An alarm state is triggered when the process value reaches the high or low set point. Hysteresis defines how far the process must return into the normal operating range before the
alarm can be cleared.
Hysteresis is a zone inside each alarm set point. This zone is defined by adding the hysteresis
value to the low set point or subtracting the hysteresis value from the high set point. View or
change hysteresis with Hysteresis a.hy (Setup Page, Alarm Menu).
High Side Alarm Range
Temperature
Hysteresis
Hysteresis
Time
Latching
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
Temperature
203
Process
Temperature
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
See the Keys and Displays chapter and the Home Page chapter for more details. An alarm
that is not latched (self-clearing) will deactivate automatically when the alarm condition has
passed. Turn latching on or off with Latching a.La (Setup Page, Alarm Menu).
Silencing
If silencing is on the operator can disable the alarm output while the controller is in an
alarm state. The process value or temperature has to enter the normal operating range
beyond the hysteresis zone to activate the alarm output function again. An active message,
such as an alarm message, will cause the display to toggle between the normal settings and
the active message in the upper display and attn in the lower display.
1. Push the Advance Key to display ignr in the upper display and the message source in
the lower display.
2. Use the Up and Down keys to scroll through possible responses, such as Clear CLr
or Silence siL. Then push the Advance or Infinity key to execute the action.
See the Keys and Displays chapter and the Home Page chapter for more details. Turn silencing on or off with Silencing asi (Setup Page, Alarm Menu).
Blocking
Blocking allows a system to warm up after it has been started up. With blocking on, an alarm
is not triggered when the process temperature is initially lower than the low set point or
higher than the high set point. The process temperature has to enter the normal operating
range beyond the hysteresis zone to activate the alarm function. If the EZ-ZONE PM has an
output that is functioning as a deviation alarm, the alarm is blocked when the set point is
changed, until the process value re-enters the normal operating range. Turn blocking on or
off with Blocking a.bL (Setup Page, Alarm Menu).
Current Sensing
When utilizing the Current Sensing capabilities of this control it is important to know that
the measurements taken utilize the AC Line Frequency aC.Lf setting found in the Global
Menu of the Setup Page. If this setting does not represent the incoming line frequency of this
controller the readings will be in error and may appear to be frozen.
Note:
If an alarm is configured to monitor current as its source, the low alarm will be effective
only when the current level is equal to or greater than 2mA. If there is no current present, the low alarm will not be activated.
204
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Read and monitor the real-time current level through the Load Current RMS Ld.Cu prompt
while the most recent faults can be read via the Current Error C.Er and Heater Error h.Er
prompts. All of these prompts can be found in the Operations Page under the Current Menu.
CT Application Note:
Alarms have to point to the correct source for the current measurement. We have one
measurement that is sampled and held CU.r. Since this is a zero cross device, in zero cross
the current is going to 0 each time the output is turned off. We also calculate an Current
RMS value that takes into account on time versus off time. Be sure alarms are pointed to
the current that is sampled and held or anytime the PID power gets low like less than 2%,
the alarm will activate or if the outputs are off such as control mode set to OFF.
205
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Security Level
1
2 3 4 5
Operations Page
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Pages
Profile Page
Factory Page
Being able to change the page security level for the Operations and Profile pages allows a
user to give access to the Profile Page while locking out the Operations Page. The following
example shows how the Lockout feature may be used to accomplish this:
Changing Security Levels:
1. From the Home Page, press and hold the Infinity Key and the Advance Key for approximately six seconds. CUst will appear in the upper display and fCty will appear in the
lower display.
2. Press the Up Key until LoC appears in the upper display and fCty will appear in the
lower display.
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
206
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
3. Press the Advance Key until Lock Operations prompt LoC.o appears in the bottom display.
4. Press the Up Key to change the default value from 2 to 3.
5. Press the Advance Key again and change the Lock Profiling prompt LoC.p appears in the
bottom display.
6. Press the Down Key to change the default value from 3 to 2.
7. Press the Advance Key until Read Lock rLoC appears in the bottom display.
8. Press the Down Key to change the default value from 5 to 2.
9. Press the Advance Key until Set Lock sLoC appears in the bottom display.
10. Press the Down Key to change the default value from 5 to 4.
With the above settings, the Home Page and the Profiling Page can be accessed, and all writable parameters can be written to. Due to the Read lock setting of 2, all pages with security
levels greater than 2 will be locked out (inaccessible).
Another example of Method 1 lockout usage could be that an operator wants read access to
all pages while allowing read/write access to the Home Page and the Lockout Menu only. To
setup this scenario follow the steps below:
1. From the Home Page, press and hold the Infinity Key and the Advance Key for approximately six seconds. CUst will appear in the upper display and fCty will appear in the
lower display.
2. Press the Up Key until LoC appears in the upper display and fCty will appear in the
lower display.
3. Press the Advance Key until Read Lock rLoC appears in the bottom display and change it
to 5.
4. Press the Advance Key until Set Lock SLoC appears in the bottom display and change it to
1.
Although the Factory Page is always visible, some menus within it can be restricted.
Security Level
0
Custom Menu
Lockout Menu*
Diagnostic
Menu**
Calibration Menu
* Using lockout Method 1 with SLoC set to 0, all writable parameters within the control
will be inhibited (not writable) with two exceptions, SLoC and rLoC. As shown below,
both of these parameters can always be seen and modified.
** Diagnostic Menu and all associated prompts are always visible and never writable
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
207
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
LoC.o
LoC.p
pas.E
rLoC
sLoC
Note:
Using Method 1 Lockout all settings can be modified by anyone who knows how to find
their way to the SLoC and rLoC parameters.
208
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
know what those passwords are to acquire a higher level of access to the control. Back out
of this menu by pushing the Infinity Key . Once out of the menu, the Password Security will
be enabled.
Differences Between a User Without Password, User With Password and Administrator
- User without a password is restricted by the Locked Access Level LoC. L.
- A User with a password is restricted by the Read Lockout Security rLoC never having
access to the Lock Menu LoC.
- An Administrator is restricted according to the Read Lockout Security rLoC however, the
Administrator has access to the Lock Menu where the Read Lockout can be changed.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
209
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
210
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
Attribute ID (1 to 255)
EtherNet/IP and DeviceNet are both based on CIP and use the same addressing scheme. In
the following menu pages notice the column header identified as CIP. There you will find the
Class, Instance and Attribute in hexadecimal, (decimal in parenthesis) which makes up the
addressing for both protocols. The Watlow implementation of CIP does not support connected explicit messages but fully supports unconnected explicit messaging.
Rockwell Automation (RA) developed the DF1 serial protocol within the framework of the
PCCC application protocol. With the introduction of CIP, the PCCC protocol was encapsulated
within it to enable continued communication over Ethernet to the legacy RA programmable
controllers, e.g., SLC, Micrologic and PLC-5 controllers equipped with Ethernet capabilities.
The Watlow implementation of CIP also supports the PCCC protocol.
EtherNet/IP (Industrial Protocol) is a network communication standard capable of handling
large amounts of data at speeds of 10 Mbps or 100 Mbps, and at up to 1,500 bytes per packet. It makes use of standard off-the-shelf Ethernet chip sets and the currently installed physical media (hardware connections). DeviceNet was the first field bus offering of the ODVA
group and has been around for many years. DeviceNet can communicate at 125, 250 and 500
kilobytes per second with a maximum limitation of 64 nodes (0 to 63) on the network.
Note:
If the control is brought back to the factory defaults (See Appendix: CIP Implicit Assembly
Structures) the user configured assemblies will be overwritten.
Note:
The maximum number of implicit input/output members using DeviceNet is 200. When using EtherNet/IP the maximum is 100.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
211
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Software Configuration
Using EZ-ZONE Configurator Software
To enable a user to configure the PM control
using a personal computer (PC), Watlow has
provided free software for your use. If you have
not yet obtained a copy of this software insert
the CD (Controller Support Tools) into your CD
drive and install the software. Alternatively,
if you are viewing this document electronically and have a connection to the Internet
simply click on the link below and and type
"configurator" into the search field. Download
the software from the Watlow web site free of charge.
http://www.watlow.com/en/resources-and-support/Technical-Library/Software-and-Demos
Once the software is installed double click on the EZ-ZONE Configurator icon placed on your
desktop during the installation process. If you cannot find the icon follow the steps below to
run the software:
1. Move your mouse to the "Start" button
2. Place the mouse over "All Programs"
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
213
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
3. Navigate to the "Watlow" folder and then the sub-folder "EZ-ZONE Configurator"
4. Click on EZ-ZONE Configurator to run.
The first screen that will appear is shown above.
If the PC is already physically connected to the EZ-ZONE PM control click the next button to
go on-line.
Note:
When establishing communications from PC to the EZ-ZONE PM controller, an interface
converter will be required. The Standard Bus network uses EIA-485 as the interface.
Most PCs today would require a USB to EIA-485 converter. However, some PCs may still
be equipped with EIA-232 ports, therefore an EIA-232 to EIA-485 converter would be required.
As can be seen in the above screen shot the software provides the user with the option of
downloading a previously saved configuration as well as the ability to create a configuration
off-line to download later. The screen shots that follow will take the user on-line.
After clicking the next button above it is necessary to define the communications port that will
be used on the PC as shown to the right. Clicking
on the drop down will allow the user to select the
appropriate communications port. This will be the
port assigned to the EIA-485 to USB converter when
it was connected to the PC. The "Advanced" button
allows the user to determine how many devices to
look for on the network (1 to 17).
After clicking on the "Next" button, the software
will scan the network for the zone addresses specified while showing the progress made (as shown in
the graphic below. When complete the software will display all of the available devices
found on the network as shown below.
The PM8 is shown highlighted to bring greater clarity to the control in focus. Any EZ-ZONE
device on the network will appear in this window and would be available for the purpose of
configuration or monitoring; simply click on the control of choice. After doing so, the screen
below will appear. In the screen shot below notice that the device part number is clearly disWat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
214
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
played at the top of the page (yellow highlight added for emphasis). When multiple EZ-ZONE
devices are on the network it is important that the part number be noted prior to configuring
so as to avoid making unwanted configuration changes to another control. Looking closely
at the left hand column (Parameter Menus) notice that it displays all of the available menus
and associated parameters within the control. The menu structure as laid out within this
software follows:
- Setup - Operations - Factory - Profile
Navigating from one menu to the next is easy and clearly visible. Simply slide the scroll bar
up or down to display the menu and parameter of choice. If there is a need to bring greater
focus and clarity to the parameters of interest simply click on the negative symbol next to
any of the Menu items. As an example if it is desired to work within the Operations page
click the negative sign next to Setup where the Setup Page will then collapse. Now click the
plus sign next to Operations to find the menu items of choice without viewing unwanted
menus and parameters. Once the focus is brought to an individual parameter (single click of
mouse) as is the case for Analog Input 1 in the left column; all that can be setup related to
that parameter will appear in the center column. The grayed out fields in the center column
simply mean that this does not apply for the type of sensor selected. As an example, notice
that when a thermocouple is selected, RTD Leads does not apply and is therefore grayed out.
To speed up the process of configuration notice that
at the bottom of the center column there is an
option to copy settings. If Analog Input 1 and 2 are
the same type of sensor click on "Copy Settings"
where a copy dialog box will appear allowing for
quick duplication of all settings. Notice too, that by
clicking on any of those items in the center column
that context sensitive help will appear for that
particular item in the right hand column.
Lastly, when the configuration is complete click the
"Finish" button at the bottom right of the previous
screen shot. The screen to the right follows this action.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
215
Cha pte r 9 Fe a tu r e s
Although the PM control now contains the configuration (because the previous discussion focused on doing the configuration on-line) it is suggested that after the configuration process
is completed that the user save this file on the PC for future use. If for some reason someone inadvertently changed a setting without understanding the impact, it would be easy and
perhaps faster to download a saved configuration back to the control versus trying to figure
out what was changed. Of course, there is an option to exit without saving a copy to the local hard drive. After selecting Save above, click the "Finish" button once again. The screen
below will than appear. When saving the configuration, note the location where the file will
be placed (saved in) and enter the file name (File name) as well. The default path for saved
files follows:
Users\"Username"\My Documents\Watlow\EZ-Zone Configurator\Saved Configurations
The user can save the file to any folder of choice.
216
Cha pte r 9 F ea tu r e s
0 to 100%
Analog Input 1
Heat
Heat Power
Source A
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Output n
Cool
0 to 100%
Output n
nc
Analog Input 1
Source A
Analog Input 2
Source B
tio Filt
n er
Output
PV Function
Se
tP
oin
t
0 to 100%
Source A
Heat
Heat Power
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Output n
Cool
0 to 100%
Output n
nc
Analog Input 1
tio Filt
n er
Source A
Output
PV Function
Se
tP
oin
t
0 to 100%
Source A
Heat
Heat Power
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Output n
Cool
0 to 100%
Output n
When function is set for Square Root, the PV Function output equals square root value of Source
A. Control loop 1 will control Analog Input 1 to Set Point 1.
Example 4: Ratio
Requirements:
Two analog inputs and the enhanced software option are required and at least one output adjusts
the controlled part of the process.
Overview:
The Ratio feature allows control of one process as a ratio of another process. This is especially
useful in applications that mix two materials, whether steam, paint or food ingredients. Analog
Input 1 monitors the controlled part of the process. Analog Input 2 of the controller measures the
part of the process that is either uncontrolled or controlled by another device. The part of the
process controlled will be maintained at a level equal to the quantity measured at input 2 multiplied by the ratio term set by the user as Set Point 1. When function is set for Ratio, the PV Function output equals Source A as a ratio to Source B. Control loop 1 will control Analog Input 1 to Set
Point 1.
Applications of ratio control:
Input 1
Output 1
mixed paint
Blending two or more flows to produce a
Input 2
mixture with specified composition.
flow
flow
controlled flow
transmitter
transmitter
of
pigment
Blending two or more flows to produce a
Mixing Tank
mixture with specified physical properuncontrolled
motorized
flow of
valve
ties.
unmixed paint
Maintaining correct air and fuel mixture
to combustion.
218
Ratio
Fu
n
cti
Analog Input 1
controlled
Source A
Analog Input 2
uncontrolled
Source B
F
on ilte
Output
PV Function
Se
tP
oin
t1
0 to 100%
Source A
Heat
Heat Power
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Output n
Cool
0 to 100%
Output n
Example 5: Differential
Requirements:
Two analog inputs and the enhanced software option are required and at least one output adjusts
the controlled part of the process.
Overview:
Differential control maintains one process at a difference to another process. When function is
set for Differential, the PV Function output equals Source A minus Source B. Control loop 1 will
control Analog Input 1 difference to Analog Input 2 based on Set Point 1.
Differential
Fu
n
cti
Analog Input 1
Source A
Analog Input 2
Source B
F
on ilte
Output
PV Function
Se
tP
oin
Input 1
t1
0 to 100%
Source A
Output 1
Input 2
Heat
Heat Power
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Output n
Cool
0 to 100%
Output n
Example 6: Cascade
Requirements:
Two loops of control, two inputs and at least 1 output and the enhanced software option.
Overview: Cascade control can handle a difficult process with minimal overshoot, while reaching the set point quickly. This minimizes damage to system components and allows for over sizing heaters for optimal heat-up rates. Heater life is also extended by reducing thermal cycling of
the heater. Systems with long lag times between the energy source (heater, steam, etc.) and the
measured process value cannot be controlled accurately or efficiently with a single control loop,
because a lot of energy can build up before a response is detected. This can cause the system to
overshoot the set point, which could damage the heater, product or heat transfer medium, such
as a heat transfer fluid.
Wat lo w E Z - Z O N E PM Integrated C ontr olle r 219
The majority of the user configuration is done via the Math function. There are two user selectable settings that will enable Cascade control, Deviation Scale or process Scale. When Process
Scale is selected the remote set point will be within the defined Range low/high and Scale low/
high settings. As an example, the graph below shows a heat/cool application where the temperature range is between 32 to 1200. With the scaling set as shown 100% cool will equate to 32,
likewise when the control is calling for 100% heat the temperature equates to 1200.
When Deviation Scale is selected the Closed Loop Set Point (SP) will not deviate beyond the specified settings. With the settings as shown in the graph below the SP (500) will not deviate beyond
25.
Range High
+1200
Process Scale
Deviation Scale
Heat
Temperature
+25
-25
Cool
Range Low
32
-100 %
Scale Low
CLSP = 500
Heat/Cool
0%
+100 %
Scale High
Heat/Cool
0%
-100 %
Scale Low
+100 %
Scale High
The graph below illustrates a system with a long lag time and the advantages in using cascade
control. Curve A represents a single-control system with PID parameters that allow a maximum
heat-up rate. Too much energy is introduced and the set point is overshot. In most long-lag-time
systems the process value may never settle out to an acceptable error. Curve C represents a
single-control system tuned to minimize overshoot. This results in unacceptable heat-up rates,
with the final value taking hours to reach. Curve B shows a cascade system that limits the energy
introduced into the system allowing an optimal heat-up rate with minimal overshoot.
Cascade
Curve A (PID)
Set
Point
Temperature
Note:
When using cascade control, two loops of
control are required. Changing the control
mode in either loop will affect both loops
of control. In other words, if loop one is
changed to manual mode, loop two will also
be changed to manual mode automatically.
Curve B (Cascade)
Curve C (Single-control)
220
Cascade control uses two control loops (outer - loop 1 and inner - loop 2) to control the process.
The outer loop (Analog Input 1) monitors the
Cascade
process or part temperature, which is then com- Outer Loop 1
He Co
at ol
S R Ra
Alg Al Set
Fu Scal cale ang nge
ori gor Po
nc e L H e L H
pared to the Set Point. The result of the compari- Process
thm ith int
t
i
on ow igh ow igh Filte
m
1
r
son, the error signal, is acted on by the PID
settings and the Range and Scale high/low setProcess Sensor
Set Point
tings. Ultimately, the outer loop produces a
Output
Analog Input 1
Control Loop 1
Source E
remote set point for the inner loop. The inner
DIO
Math Function
or
Function Key
loop input (Analog input 2) monitors the energy
source (heating and cooling), which is compared Inner Loop 2
Energy
to the remote set point generated by the outer
loop. The result of the comparison, the error
-100% = Range Low
Output n
+100% = Range High
signal, is acted on by the PID settings in the
Heat
0 to 100%
Remote Set
Heat Power
Energy Source
Point
cascade inner loop (2), which generates an outCool Power
Analog Input 2
0 to 100%
Cool
put power level between -100% to +100%. If the
Control Loop 2
Output n
power level is positive the heat will be on; if the
power level is negative the cool will come on.
Power from the energy sources are supplied by the outputs of choice always referenced to Control
loop 2.
Outer Loop
When cascade control is disabled (Source E
is true), the Math function output will equal
Control Loop 1, Set Point.
Thermocouple
Input 1
Oil In
Output 1
Oil Out
Input 2
Note:
If an input sensor on the outer loop fails
when using deviation cascade the inner loop
will continue to drive the output.
Limit
Heater
Inner Loop
Thermocouple
Limit Thermocouple
Lube Oil Tank
tP
int
1
Requirements:
Output n
0 to 100%
Two analog inputs and at least one output are
Heat
Heat Power
Analog Input 1
Source A
required to adjust the controlled part of the
Cool Power
Cool
processes.
Control Loop 1
0 to 100%
Temperature
Output n
Overview:
Fu
n
cti Fi
Wet Bulb/Dry Bulb is a configuration where a
on lte
r
dry bulb connected to Analog Input 1 measures
temperature on Analog Input 1. A wet bulb
Source B
sensor that is maintained with moisture has air
Analog Input 2
Output
Source A
moved over the sensor. As moisture evaporates
PV Function
Se
tP
from the wet bulb, the temperature drops. A
oin
t2
Output n
wet bulb input on Analog Input 2, in combina0 to 100%
Heat
tion with the dry bulb temperature, senses
Heat Power
Source A
relative humidity. The controller calculates the
Cool Power
Cool
0 to 100%
Control Loop 2
temperature difference between the two senHumidity
Output n
sors to determine percent relative humidity.
The humidify and dehumidify outputs are disabled when Analog Input 1 temperature falls below
32 F/0 C, or goes above 212 F/100 C. When function is set for Wet Bulb/Dry Bulb, the PV Function
output equals calculated humidity. Control loop 1 will control Analog Input 1 to Set Point 1. Control loop 2 will control Analog Input 2 to Set Point 2.
Example 8: Vaisala
Requirements:Two analog inputs and the enhanced software option are required and at least two
outputs adjusts the controlled temperature and humidity processes.
Overview:
Vaisala Model HMM-30C Solid-state Relative Humidity Sensor is supported with the Vaisala configuration. Analog Input 1 is used to measure temperature and Analog Input 2 must be a process input
connected to a Vaisala sensor. The controller provides temperature compensation for the Vaisala
sensor. The humidify and dehumidify outputs are disabled when Analog Input 1 temperature falls
below -40 F/- 40 C, or goes above 320 F/160 C. When function is set for Vaisala, the PV Function
output equals the calculated relative humidity compensated by the sensor on Analog Input 1.
Vaisala
Se
tP
oin
t1
Output n
0 to 100%
Analog Input 1
Heat Power
Source A
Cool Power
Control Loop 1
Temperature
Fu
nc
tio
0 to 100%
Heat
Cool
Output n
Fil
ter
Source B
Analog Input 2
Source A
Output
PV Function
Se
tP
oin
t2
Output n
0 to 100%
Source A
Heat Power
Cool Power
Control Loop 2
Humidity
222
0 to 100%
Heat
Cool
Output n
oint 1
Set P
ithim
Algor
im
lgorith
an d
dB
Dea
e
l Tim
ave
e Tr
Valv
Cool
Heat A
A typical scenario where a motorized valve is used is to regulate the flow of fluid which in turn
impacts the loop process value. A valve is opened or closed by closing contacts to drive the value
in the intended direction. Motorized Valves come in a number of configurations. Some valves have
a position feedback mechanism that allows the control to measure the valves position via an
internal potentiometer called slide-wire. The controller can measure the potentiometer resistance to determine the initial valve position on power up.
This method may not be desirable
Motorized Valve Control
for three reasons:
1) It requires a second input on the
controller to measure valve posiOutput n
tion.
Special Function
2) The controller and the valve are
Output 1
Close
Source A
Analog Input 1
Heat Power
Source Function A
more expensive.
Open
Special Function
3) Additional wiring is required for
Output 2
Control Loop 1
Special Output Function 1
the slide-wire feedback.
Output n
Other valves take an analog signal
and have a localized control mechanism that regulates the valve position. These are typically
more expensive valves because of the control mechanism built-in plus it requires an analog signal which is not always available. The actual valve position is not critical because it is a part of a
closed loop control.
The Motorized Valve control algorithm is also designed to work with a type of valve that provides
two discrete signals: one to open the valve and another to close the valve. The algorithm turns
on/off the appropriate signal for an appropriate amount of time to approximate the valve position. This works when the valve is inside a closed control loop because when the valve is not in
the correct position, the PID algorithm will adjust the valve further open or close as needed.
These valves have travel limit switches which deactivates the motor once the valve is fully open
or fully closed so the controller can not cause the valve to over travel and burn out the motor, or
the motor is built so it can not overheat at max locked rotor amperes.
To use the motorized feature, the user programs the Special Output Function to Motorized Valve.
Then the Source Function A is selected to either
Heat or Cool Power and Source Instance A is set to
match the control loop, typically 1.
Gas Furnace
Output 1 = Close
Output 2 = Open
Valve
Actuator
Gas Flow
Temperature
Sensor
Lastly, assign an output to Special Output Function 1 that is wired to close the valve. Assign an
output to Special Output Function 2 that is wired to open the valve. Typically, these two outputs
are normally open mechanical relays but solid state relays or switch DC outputs may be programmed in the same manner.
Definitions:
- Current Position is an approximation of the valve's position as it relates to a power level (0 100%) where 0% is fully closed and 100% is fully open.
- Dead Time is the minimum on time that the valve will travel once it is turned on in either the
closed or open direction. Dead Time = Valve Dead Band / 100 * Valve Travel Time.
- Valve Travel Time is the amount of time the valve needs to be turned on (either open or close)
to eliminate the error between the estimated valve position and the desired power level. A positive On Time value indicates the need to open the valve while a negative value indicates the
need to close the valve. On Time = (Input 1 Value - Current Position) / 100 * Valve Travel Time
When power is applied to the controller, the valve is closed and time is set to 0.
- Special Output Function 1 is the close signal to the valve.
- Special Output Function 2 is the open signal to the valve
224
Description
Possible Cause(s)
Corrective Action
Alarm wont
Alarm will not clear Latching is active
clear or reset or reset with keypad
or digital input
Alarm wont
occur
Alarm Error
AL.E1
AL.E2
AL.E3
AL.E4
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
225
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Indication
Alarm Low
AL.L1
AL.L2
AL.L3
AL.L4
Alarm High
AL.h1
AL.h2
AL.h3
AL.h4
Error Input
Er.i1
Er.i2
Description
Limit Error
Li.E1
Corrective Action
Possible Cause(s)
Ambient error - cold junc- Return to factory for retion circuitry not working
pair
226
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Indication
Description
Possible Cause(s)
Corrective Action
Limit Low
rp2
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
227
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Indication
Autotuning
tUn1
tUn2
Description
Possible Cause(s)
Controller is
User started the
autotuning the conautotune function
trol loop
Corrective Action
Wait until autotune completes or disable autotune
feature
No heat/cool
action
No Display
Wiring error
Turn on power
Replace fuse
Reset breaker
Close interlock switch
Reset limit
228
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Indication
Description
Possible Cause(s)
Corrective Action
No Serial Com- Cannot establish se- Address parameter incor- Set unique addresses on
munication
rial communications
rect
network
with the controller Incorrect protocol se Match protocol between
devices
lected
Match baud rate between
Baud rate incorrect
devices
Match parity between de Parity incorrect
vices
Correct wiring issue
Wiring error
EIA-485 converter issue Check settings or replace
converter
Set correct communica Incorrect computer or
tion port
PLC communications port
Incorrect software setup Correct software setup to
match controller
Wires routed with power Route communications
cables
wires away from power
wires
Process
doesnt control to set
point
Temperature
runway
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
229
Indication
Device Error
100
rEtn
Heater Error
h.Er
Current Error
C.Er
Menus inaccessible
Description
Controller displays
internal malfunction message at
power up.
Possible Cause(s)
Corrective Action
Unable to access
sEt, opEr, fCty
or prof menus or
particular prompts
in Home Page
Controller defective
230
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Indication
EZ-Key/s do
not work
uaL.L
Description
Possible Cause(s)
Corrective Action
EZ-Key/s do not
activate required
function
Incorrect setup
Shorted
Open
Reversed
Shorted
Open
Reversed
Open
Shorted
Reversed
S1 open
S2 open
Not implemented.
S3 open
S1 short to S2
Yes, pulled up
RTD
S1 short to S3
S2 shorted to S3
S1 and S2 open
S1 and S3 open
S2 and S3 open
S1 open
S3 open
S1 short to S3
S1 and S3 open
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
231
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Once the parameters of choice have been defined and written to the specified pointer registers, the working registers will then represent the parameters written. In the example
above, the 32-bit floating point analog input (360 and 361) was first written to registers 40
and 41 which in turn defines working registers 200 and 201 as Analog Input 1. As can be seen
in the far right-hand column in the graphic above, reading back registers 200 and 201 the
temperature, as detected by the first analog input is displayed.
The screen shot above was taken from a program that can be found on the Watlow Support Tools DVD (shipped with the product) as well as on the Watlow website. On the DVD,
it can be found under "Utility Tools" and is identified as "Modbus TCP Diagnostic Program for
EZ-ZONE PM, RM and ST". A similar program can be found here as well for Modbus RTU. If it
is easier to go to the web to acquire this software, click on the link below and type "modbus"
in the search field where both versions can be found and downloaded. http://www.watlow.
com/en/resources-and-support/Technical-Library/Software-and-Demos
232
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
41
43
45
47
49
51
53
55
57
59
61
63
65
67
69
71
73
75
77
79
81
83
85
87
89
91
93
95
97
99
101
103
105
107
109
111
113
115
117
119
Working Registers
200
202
204
206
208
210
212
214
216
218
220
222
224
226
228
230
232
234
236
238
240
242
244
246
248
250
252
254
256
256
260
262
264
266
268
270
272
274
276
278
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
&
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
201
203
205
207
209
211
213
215
217
219
221
223
225
227
229
231
233
235
237
239
241
243
245
247
249
251
253
255
257
259
261
263
265
267
269
271
273
275
277
279
233
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Registers 42 & 43
Pointer 2 = 2160 & 2161
Set Point
Registers 44 & 45
Pointer 3 = 2162 & 2163
Manual Power
Registers 46 & 47
Pointer 4 = 1480 & 1481
Alarm 1 High Set Point
Registers 48 & 49
Pointer 5 = 1482 & 1483
Alarm 1 Low Set Point
Registers 50 & 51
Pointer 6 = 1530 & 1531
Alarm 2 High Set Point
Registers 52 & 53
Pointer 7 = 1532 & 1533
Alarm 2 Low Set Point
Registers 54 & 55
Pointer 8 = 1580 & 1581
Alarm 3 High Set Point
Registers 56 & 57
Pointer 9 = 1582 & 1583
Alarm 3 Low Set Point
Registers 58 & 59
Pointer 10 = 1630 & 1631
Alarm 4 High Set Point
Registers 60 & 61
Pointer 11 = 1632 & 1633
Alarm 4 Low Set Point
Registers 62 & 63
Pointer 12 = 2540 & 2541
Profile Action Request
Registers 64 & 65
Pointer 13 = 2520 & 2521
Profile Start
Registers 66 & 67
Pointer 14 = 1890 & 1891
Heat Proportional Band
Registers 68 & 69
Pointer 15 = 1892 & 1893
Cool Proportional Band
Registers 70 & 71
Pointer 16 = 1894 & 1895
Time Integral
Registers 72 & 73
Pointer 17 = 1896 & 1897
Time Derivative
Registers 74 & 75
Pointer 18 = 1900 & 1901
On/Off Heat Hysteresis
Registers 76 & 77
Pointer 19 = 1902 & 1903
On/Off Cool Hysteresis
Registers 78 & 79
Pointer 20 = 1898 & 1899
Deadband
Assembly Working
Addresses
Registers 200 & 201
Value of Pointer 1
Assembly Pointer
Registers
Registers 80 & 81
Pointer 21 = 360 & 361
Analog Input 1
Value
Registers 82 & 83
Pointer 22 = 362 & 363
Analog Input 1 Error
Registers 84 & 85
Pointer 23 = 440 & 441
Analog Input 2
Value
Registers 86 & 87
Pointer 24 = 442 & 443
Analog Input 2 Error
Registers 88 & 89
Pointer 25 = 1496 & 1497
Alarm 1 State
Registers 90 & 91
Pointer 26 = 1546 & 1547
Alarm 2 State
Registers 92 & 93
Pointer 27 = 1596 & 1597
Alarm 3 State
Registers 94 & 95
Pointer 28 = 1646 & 1647
Alarm 4 State
Registers 96 & 97
Pointer 29 = 1328 & 1329
Digital Input 5 Status
Registers 98 & 99
Pointer 30 = 1348 & 1349
Digital Input 6 Status
Assembly Working
Addresses
Registers 240 & 241
Value of Pointer 21
234
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Assembly
Class, Instance,
Attribute
ST Data
Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
Parameter
Loop 1 - Control Mode
Loop 1 - Set Point
Loop 1 - Manual Power
Alarm 1 - High Set Point
Alarm 1 - Low Set Point
Alarm 2 - High Set Point
Alarm 2 - Low Set Point
Alarm 3 - High Set Point
Alarm 3 - Low Set Point
Alarm 4 - High Set Point
Alarm 4 - Low Set Point
Profile Action Request
Profile Start
Loop 1 - Heat Proportional Band
Loop 1 - Cool Proportional Band
Loop 1 - Time Integral
Loop 1 - Time Derivative
Loop 1 - Heat Hysteresis
Loop 1 - Cool Hysteresis
Loop 1 - Dead Band
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
Parameter
Class, Instance,
Attribute
PLC
Data Type
DINT
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
DINT
DINT
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
-------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
PM revision 15 and above firmware allows for 40 implicit members. Revisions below 15 allow for a maximum of 20.
Note:
Although 40 members are built into PM/RM controllers, the RUI allows for a maximum of
20. If 40 members are needed, consider using the EZ-ZONE RMA module.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
235
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Assembly
Class, Instance,
Attribute
ST Data
Type
---1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Cannot be changed
0x77, 0x02, 0x01
0x77, 0x02, 0x02
0x77, 0x02, 0x03
0x77, 0x02, 0x04
0x77, 0x02, 0x05
0x77, 0x02, 0x06
0x77, 0x02, 0x07
0x77, 0x02, 0x08
0x77, 0x02, 0x09
0x77, 0x02, 0x0A
0x77, 0x02, 0x0B
0x77, 0x02, 0x0C
0x77, 0x02, 0x0D
0x77, 0x02, 0x0E
0x77, 0x02, 0x0F
0x77, 0x02, 0x10
0x77, 0x02, 0x11
0x77, 0x02, 0x12
0x77, 0x02, 0x13
0x77, 0x02, 0x14
0x77, 0x02, 0x15
0x77, 0x02, 0x16
0x77, 0x02, 0x17
0x77, 0x02, 0x18
0x77, 0x02, 0x19
0x77, 0x02, 0x1A
0x77, 0x02, 0x1B
0x77, 0x02, 0x1C
0x77, 0x02, 0x1D
0x77, 0x02, 0x1E
0x77, 0x02, 0x1F
0x77, 0x02, 0x20
0x77, 0x02, 0x21
0x77, 0x02, 0x22
0x77, 0x02, 0x23
0x77, 0x02, 0x24
0x77, 0x02, 0x25
0x77, 0x02, 0x26
0x77, 0x02, 0x27
0x77, 0x02, 0x28
Binary
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
Parameter
Device Status
Analog Input 1, Analog Input Value
Analog Input 1, Input Error
Analog Input 2, Analog Input Value
Analog Input 2, Input Error
Alarm 1, Alarm State
Alarm 2, Alarm State
Alarm 3, Alarm State
Alarm 4, Alarm State
Event Status 1
Event Status 2
Loop 1 - Control Mode Active
Loop 1 - Heat Power
Loop 1 - Cool Power
Limit State
Profile Start
Profile Action Request
Current Profile
Current Step
Loop 1 - Active Set Point
Step Time Remaining
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
None Specified
Parameter
Class, Instance,
Attribute
PLC
Data Type
None
0x68, 0x01, 0x01
0x68, 0x01. 0x02
0x68, 0x02, 0x01
0x68, 0x02, 0x02
0x6D, 0x01, 0x09
0x6D, 0x02, 0x09
0x6D, 0x03, 0x09
0x6D, 0x04, 0x09
0x6E, 0x01, 0x05
0x6E, 0x02, 0x05
0x97, 0x01, 0x02
0x97, 0x01, 0x0D
0x97, 0x01, 0x0E
0x70, 0x01, 0x06
0x7A, 0x01, 0x01
0x7A, 0x01, 0x0B
0x7A, 0x01, 0x03
0x7A, 0x01, 0x04
0x7A, 0x01, 0x05
0x7A, 0x01, 0x09
-------------------------------------------------------------
BIN
REAL
REAL
REAL
REAL
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
REAL
REAL
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
DINT
REAL
DINT
-------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
The first T to O member above (Device Status) is always present but not counted when
configuring the gateway size using the RUI or EZ-ZONE Configurator software. However, it
most always be counted when configuring the input size of the Master. As an example, if
using the DINT comm format in a PLC and the entire assembly as shown above, the input
size would require 21 members.
Note:
Although 40 members are built into PM/RM controllers, the RUI allows for a maximum of
20. If 40 members are needed, consider using the EZ-ZONE RMA module.
236
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
As can be seen on the previous pages, the PM Implicit Assembly defaults (factory settings)
to a populated assembly structure for the first 20 members. If it is desired to modify any of
the given assembly members there are many software tools available to do so, one of which
is available on the Watlow website. Click on the link below and then type "implicit" into the
keyword field and click the search button.
http://www.watlow.com/en/resources-and-support/Technical-Library/Software-and-Demos
Click on and save the program named "EZ-ZONE Implicit Message Assembly Programming Application" to a location on your local storage device. To learn more about working with the
implicit assemblies turn to the section within this user document
entitled Modifying Implicit Assembly Members.
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
237
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
1A
C = 0x71 (113)
Analog Input
I = 1 to 4
Read
A=1
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
21
20
19
18
17
16
21
20
19
18
17
16
21
20
19
18
17
16
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
21
20
19
18
17
16
21
20
19
18
17
16
22
Instance i
Class,
Instance, Attribute
2A
C = 0x71 (113)
Control
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=2
Assembly
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
22
Set Point
Bits 16 to 31, Signed 16 bits with implied tenths precision (-32768.8 to 3276.7)
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
3A
C = 0x71 (113)
Control
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=3
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
22
Set Point
Bits 16 to 31, Signed 16 bits with implied tenths precision (-32768.8 to 3276.7)
Instance i
Class,
Instance, Attribute
4A
C = 0x71 (113)
Control
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=4
Assembly
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
Class,
Instance, Attribute
5A
C = 0x71 (113)
Control
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=5
Assembly
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
6A
C = 0x71 (113)
Limit
I = 1 to 4
Read
A=6
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
22
23
22
Input
Limit State
Analog Input Value
Error
Status
Bits 16 to 28, Signed 16 bits whole (-4096 to 4095)
Bit 29, Analog Input Error Status (0 = None, 1 = Error)
Bits 30 and 31, Limit State (00 =None, 01 = Low Limit, 10 = Limit High, 11 = Other)
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
31
Instance, Attribute
7A
C = 0x71 (113)
Spare
Limit
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=7
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Clear
Latched
Analog Input Value
Error
Bits 16 to 28, Signed 13 bits whole (-4096 to 4095)
Bit 29, Clear Latched Input Error (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Bits 30, Limit Clear (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Limit
Clear
238
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Assembly
15
14
1B
Input
Error
Status
Loop
Error
Status
13
12
Actual
Control
Mode
11
10
Tune
Status
Bits 0 to 10, Signed 10 bits with implied tenths precision (-100.0 to 100.0)
Bit 11, Loop Tuning Status (0 = Off, 1 = Anything Else)
Bits 12 and 13, Actual Control Mode (00 = Off, 01 = Manual, 10 = Auto)
Bit 14, Loop Error Status (0 = None, 1 = Error)
Bit 15, Analog Input Error (0 = None, 1 = Error)
Instance i
15
14
Spare
Open
Loop
Clear
Assembly
2B
13
12
Control Mode
11
10
Initiate
Tune
Manual Power
Bits 0 to 10, Signed 10 bits with implied tenths precision (-100.0 to 100.0)
Bit 11, Initiate Tune (0 = No, 1 = Yes)
Bits 12 and 13, Actual Control Mode (00 = Off, 01 = Manual, 10 = Auto)
Bit 14, Open Loop Clear (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Instance i
Assembly
15
14
13
12
11
10
3B
Set Point
Bits 0 to 15, Signed 16 bits with implied tenths precision (-3276.8 to 3276.8)
Instance i
Assembly
15
14
13
12
11
10
4B
Time Integral
Bits 0 to 15, Unsigned 16 bits whole (0 to 65535)
Instance i
Assembly
15
14
13
12
11
10
5B
Time Derivative
Bits 0 to 15, Unsigned 16 bits whole (0 to 65535)
Instance i
Assembly
6B
15
14
Limit State
13
Input
Error
Status
12
11
10
Instance i
Assembly
7B
15
Spare
14
13
12
11
10
Clear
Limit
Clear Latched
Error
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
239
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Instance i + 15
Instance i + 14
31
29
30
Limit State
28
Limit State
Instance i + 13
27
Instance i + 12
25
26
24
Limit State
Limit State
Instance i + 11 Instance i + 10
22
23
Limit State
21
20
Limit State
Instance i + 9
Instance i + 8
18
17 16
19
Limit State
Limit State
Bits 16 to 31, Paired bits representing the state of up to 16 limits (00 = None, 01 = Limit low,, 10 = Limit High)
Instance i + 15
Class,
31
Instance, Attribute
9A
C = 0x71 (113)
Limit
Spare
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A=9
Assembly
30
Clear
Limit
Instance i + 14
29
28
Spare
Clear
Limit
Instance i + 13
27
26
Spare
Clear
Limit
Instance i + 12
25
24
Instance i + 11 Instance i + 10
22
23
21
20
Instance i + 9
Instance i + 8
18
17 16
19
Clear
Clear
Spare Clear Spare Clear Spare Clear Spare Limit Spare Limit
Limit
Limit
Limit
Bits 16 to 31, Paired bits representing the state of up to 16 limits (00 = None, 01 = Limit low,, 10 = Limit High)
Instance i
Class,
Instance, Attribute
10 A
C = 0x71 (113)
Limit
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A = 0x0A (10)
Assembly
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
22
23
22
21
17 16
20
19
18
20
19
18
17 16
Instance i + 9
Instance i + 8
18
17 16
Clear
Clear
Spare
High Limit Set Point
Latched
Limit
Error
Bits 16 to 28, Signed 13 bits whole (-4096 to 4095) - Bit 29, Clear Latched Input Error (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Bits 30, Limit Clear (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
11 A
C = 0x71 (113)
CT
I = 1 to 4
Read
A = 0x0B (11)
31
Spare
30
29
Heater Error
28
27
25
26
24
21
Current RMS
Current Error
Assembly
12 A
Alarm
Read
Class,
Instance, Attribute
C = 0x71 (113)
I = 1 to 4
A = 0x0C (12)
Instance i + 15
Instance i + 14
31
29
30
Alarm State
28
Alarm State
Instance i + 13
27
Instance i + 12
25
26
24
Instance i + 11 Instance i + 10
23
22
21
20
19
Alarm State Alarm State Alarm State Alarm State Alarm State
Alarm State
Bits 16 to 31, Paired bits reflecting the state of up to 16 alarms (00 = None, 01 = Alarm Low, 10 = Alarm High, 11 = Other)
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
13 A
C = 0x71 (113)
Alarm
I = 1 to 4
Read/Write
A = 0x0D (13)
Instance i + 15
Instance i + 14
31
29
30
Clear Alarm
28
Silence Alarm
Instance i + 13
27
Instance i + 12
26
Clear Alarm
25
24
Silence
Alarm
Instance i + 11 Instance i + 10
23
22
Clear Alarm
21
20
Silence
Alarm
Instance i + 9
Instance i + 8
18
17 16
19
Clear Alarm
Silence
Alarm
Bits 16 to 31, Paired bits reflecting the state of up to 16 alarms (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
240
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Assembly
8B
15
Instance i + 6
14
13
Limit State
Instance i + 5
11
12
Limit State
Instance i + 3
Instance i + 4
10
Limit State
Limit State
Limit State
Instance i + 1
Instance i + 2
Limit State
Limit State
Instance i
Limit State
Bits 0 to 15, Paired bits representing the state of up to 16 limits (00 = None, 01 = Limit low,, 10 = Limit High)
Instance i + 7
Assembly
9B
15
14
Spare
Clear
Limit
Instance i + 6
13
Spare
Instance i + 5
11
12
Clear
Limit
Instance i + 4
10
Clear Spare
Limit
Spare
Instance i + 3
Clear
Limit
Spare
Clear
Limit
5
Spare
Instance i
Instance i + 1
Instance i + 2
Clear
Limit
Spare
Clear
Limit
Spare
Clear
Limit
Bits 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12 and 14, Limit Clear for instance i to instance i ( 0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Instance i
Assembly
15
10 B
14
13
12
11
10
Spare
Instance i
Assembly
15
11 B
Spare
14
13
Heater Error
12
11
10
Current Error
Current RMS
Bits 11 and 12, Current Error (00 = None, 01 = Shorted, 10 = Open)
Bits 13 and 14, Heater Error (00 = None, 01 = Low, 10 = High)
Instance i + 7
Assembly
12 B
15
14
Alarm State
Instance i + 6
13
Instance i + 5
12
Alarm State
11
10
Alarm State
Instance i + 4
Alarm State
Instance i + 3
Alarm State
Instance i + 1
Instance i + 2
Alarm State
Alarm State
Instance i
Alarm State
Bits 0 to 15, Paired bits reflecting the state of up to 16 alarms (00 = None, 01 = Alarm Low, 10 = Alarm High, 11 = Other)
Instance i + 7
Assembly
13 B
15
14
Clear Alarm
Instance i + 6
13
12
Silence Alarm
Instance i + 5
11
10
Clear Alarm
Instance i + 4
8
Silence
Alarm
Instance i + 3
Clear Alarm
Instance i + 1
Instance i + 2
Silence Alarm
Clear Alarm
Instance i
Silence Alarm
Bits 0 to 15, Paired bits reflecting the state of up to 16 alarms (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
241
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Assembly
14 A
Alarm
Read/Write
Class,
27
25 24 23
28
26
31
30
29
Instance, Attribute
C = 0x71 (113)
Alarm
I = 1 to 4
Alarm, High Set Point
Clear
A = 0x0E (14)
Bits 16 to 30, Signed 15 bits with implied tenths precision (-1638.4 to 1638.3)
Bit 31, Alarm Clear (0 = Ignore, 1 = Clear)
22
21
20
19
18
17 16
22
21
20
19
18
17 16
22
21
20
19
18
17 16
Instance i + 9
Instance i + 8
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
27
25 24 23
28
26
31
30
29
Instance, Attribute
15 A
C = 0x71 (113)
Input
Analog Input
I = 1 to 4
Filtered, Analog Input Value
Error
Read
A = 0x0F (15)
Status
Bits 16 to 30, Signed 15 bits with implied tenths precision (-1638.4 to 1638.3)
Bit 31, Analog Input Error (0 = None, 1 = Error)
Instance i + 1
Class,
Assembly
Instance, Attribute
16 A
C = 0x71 (113)
Analog Input
I = 1 to 4
Read
A = 0x10 (16)
31
30
29
28
27
25
26
24
23
Instance i + 15
Instance i + 14
Instance i + 13
Instance i + 12
Instance i + 11 Instance i + 10
Class,
Assembly
27
25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
28
26
31
30
29
Instance, Attribute
17 A
C = 0x71 (113)
Input
Input
Input Spare Input Spare Input Spare Input Spare Input Spare Input
Spare Error
Spare
Spare
Analog Input I = 1 to 4
Error
Error
Error
Error
Error
Error
Error
Read
A = 0x11 (17)
Bits 16, 18, 20, 22, 24, 26, 28, 30, Analog Input Error Status (0 = None, 1 = Error)
242
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Assembly
15
14 B
Alarm
Silence
14
11
12
13
10
Spare
Input
Error
Instance i
Assembly
15
15 B
Input
Error
Status
14
12
13
11
10
Instance i
Assembly
15
14
12
13
11
10
16 B
Bits 0 to 15, Signed 16 bits with implied tenths precision (-3276.8 to 3276.8)
Instance i + 7
Assembly
17 B
15
Spare
Instance i + 6
14
13
Input
Error
Spare
12
Instance i + 5
11
Input
Error Spare
10
Instance i + 4
Input
Error Spare
8
Input
Error
Instance i + 3
Instance i
Instance i + 1
Instance i + 2
Spare
Input
Error
Spare
Input
Error
Spare
Input
Error
Bits 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, Analog Input Error Status(0 = None, 1 = Error)
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
243
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
PM Specifications
LineVoltage/Power (Minimum/Maximum Ratings)
85 to 264V (ac), 47 to 63Hz
20 to 28V (ac), 47 to 63Hz
12 to 40V (dc)
14VA maximum power consumption (PM4, 8 & 9)
10VA maximum power consumption (PM6)
Data retention upon power failure via non-volatile memory
Compliant with SEMIF47-0200, Figure R1-1 voltage sag requirements @ 24V (ac) or higher
Environment
0 to 149F (-18 to 65C) operating temperature
-40 to 185F (-40 to 85C) storage temperature
0 to 90% RH, non-condensing
Accuracy
Calibration accuracy and sensor conformity: 0.1% of span, 1C @ the calibrated ambient
temperature and rated line voltage
Types R, S, B; 0.2%
Type T below -50C; 0.2%
Calibration ambient temperature @ 77 5F (25 3C)
Accuracy span :1000 F (540C) min.
Temperature stability: 0.1 F/F (0.1C/C) rise in ambient max.
Agency Approvals
UL Listed to UL 61010-1 File E185611
UL Reviewed to CSA C22.2 No.61010-1-04
UL 50 Type 4X, NEMA 4X indoor locations, IP65 front panel seal (indoor use only)
FM Class 3545 File 3029084 temperature limit switches
CE-See Declaration of Conformity RoHS and W.E.E.E. complaint
ODVA-EtherNet/IP and DeviceNet Compliance
UL Listed to ANSI/ISA 12.12.01-2007 File E184390
This equipment is suitable for use in Class 1, Div.2, Groups A, B, C and D or non-hazardous
locations only. Temperature Code T4A
UL reviewed to Standard No. CSA C22.2 No.213-M1987, Canadian Hazardous locations
All models, CSA C22.2 No. 24 File 158031 Class 4813-02, CSA Approved
Controller
User selectable heat/cool, on-off, P, PI, PD, PID or alarm action, not valid for limit controllers
Auto-tune with TRU-TUNE+ adaptive control algorithm
Control sampling rates: input = 10Hz, outputs = 10Hz
244
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Universal Input
Thermocouple, grounded or ungrounded sensors
-- >20M input impedance
Max. 2k source resistance
3A open sensor detection
RTD 2- or 3-wire, platinum, 100 and 1k @ 0C (32F) calibration to DIN curve (0.00385
//C)
Process, 0-20mA @100, or 0-10V (dc) @ 20k input impedance; scalable, 0-50mV
Voltage Input Ranges
- Accuracy 10mV 1 LSD at standard conditions
- Temperature stability 100 PPM/C maximum
Milliamp Input Ranges
- Accuracy 20A 1 LSD at standard conditions
- Temperature stability 100 PPM/C maximum
Resolution Input Ranges
- 0 to 10V: 200V nominal
- 0 to 20mA: 0.5mA nominal
Potentiometer: 0 to 1.2k
Inverse scaling
Current: input range is 0 to 50mA, 100 input impedance
Response time: 1 second max., accuracy 1mA typical
Input Type
Accuracy
Range Low
Accuracy
Range High
Units
J
K
T
1.75
2.45
1.55
0
-200
-200
750
1250
350
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
245
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Input Type
Accuracy
Range Low
Accuracy
Range High
Units
N
E
R
S
B
C
D
F (PTII)
RTD, 100 ohm
RTD, 1000 ohm
mV
2.25
2.10
3.9
3.9
2.66
3.32
3.32
2.34
2.00
2.00
0.05
0
-200
0
0
870
0
0
0
-200
-200
-50
1250
900
1450
1450
1700
2315
2315
1343
800
800
50
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
Deg C
DegC
mV
Volts
0.01
10
Volts
mAdc
0.02
20
mAmps DC
mAac
50
mAmps AC
Operating Range
Input Type
J
K
T
N
E
R
S
B
C
D
F (PTII)
RTD (100 ohm)
RTD (1000 ohm)
mV
Volts
mAdc
mAac
Potentiometer, 1K range
Resistance, 5K range
Resistance, 10K range
Resistance, 20K range
Resistance, 40K range
Range Low
-210
-270
-270
-270
-270
-50
-50
0
0
0
0
-200
-200
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Range High
1200
1371
400
1300
1000
1767
1767
1816
2315
2315
1343
800
800
50
10
20
50
1200
5000
10000
20000
40000
246
Units
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
Deg
mV
Volts
mAmps DC
mAmps AC
Ohms
Ohms
Ohms
Ohms
Ohms
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Thermistor Input
Input Type
Thermistor,
Thermistor,
Thermistor,
Thermistor,
5K range
10K range
20K range
40K range
Max Error @
25 Deg C
5
10
20
40
Accuracy
Range Low
0
0
0
0
Accuracy Range
High
5000
10000
20000
40000
Units
Ohms
Ohms
Ohms
Ohms
Base R @ 25C
Alpha
Techniques
Beta
THERM
YSI
Thermistor
Curve
2.252K
10K
10K
Curve A
Curve A
Curve C
2.2K3A
10K3A
10K4A
004
016
006
A
B
C
Current Measurement
Accepts 0 - 50mA signal (user programmable range)
Displayed operating range and resolution can be scaled and are user programmable
Requires optional current transformer
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
247
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
Output Hardware
Switched DC
- Maximum open circuit voltage is 22 to 25V (dc)
- 30mA max. per single output / 40mA max. total per paired outputs (1 & 2, 3 & 4)
- Typical drive; 4.5V (dc) @ 30mA
- Short circuit limited to <50mA
- Use dc- and dc+ to drive external solid-state relay
- 1-pole DIN-A-MITE: up to 4 in parallel or 4 in series
- 2-pole DIN-A-MITE: up to 2 in parallel or 2 in series
- 3-pole DIN-A-MITE: up to 2 in series
Switched dc/open collector = 30V (dc) max. @ 100mA max. current sink
Solid State Relay (SSR), FormA, 0.5A @ 24V (ac) min., 240V (ac) max., 1A at 50F linear
derating to 0.5A at 149F resistive, opto-isolated, without contact suppression, 120/240V
(ac) 20 VA pilot duty
- Minimum holding current of 10mA
Electromechanical relay, Form C, 5A, 24 to 240V (ac) or 30V (dc) max., resistive load,
100,000 cycles at rated load, 125 VA pilot duty at 120/240V (ac), 25 VA at 24V (ac)
Electromechanical relay, Form A, 5A, 24 to 240V (ac) or 30V (dc) max., resistive load,
100,000 cycles at rated load, 125 VA pilot duty at 120/240V (ac), 25 VA at 24V (ac)
NO-ARC relay, Form A, 15A, 24 to 240V (ac), no V (dc), resistive load, 2 million cycles at
rated load
Universal process/retransmit, Output range selectable:
- 0 to 10V (dc) into a min. 1k load
- 0 to 20mA into max. 800 load
Resolution
- dc ranges: 2.5mV nominal
- mA ranges: 5A nominal
Calibration Accuracy
- dc ranges: 15mV
Wat l o w E Z - Z O N E PMI C ontrol l er
248
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
- mA ranges: 30A
Temperature Stability
- 100 ppm/C
Operator Interface
Dual 4 digit, 7 segment LED displays
Advance, infinity, up and down keys, plus optional programmable EZ-KEY/s depending on
model size
Typical display update rate 1Hz
RESET key substituted for infinity on all models including the limit control
Dimensions
Size
Behind Panel
(max.)
1/4
100.8 mm
(3.97 in)
1/16
101.6 mm
(4.00 in)
1/8
(H)
101.6 mm
(4.00 in)
1/8 (V)
101.6 mm
(4.00 in)
Width
100.3
mm
(3.95
in)
53.3
mm
(2.10
in)
100.3
mm
(3.95
in)
54.8
mm
(2.16
in)
Height
100.3 mm
(3.95 in)
53.3 mm
(2.10 in)
54.8 mm
(2.16 in)
100.3 mm
(3.95 in)
Weight
1/4 DIN (PM4)
Controller: 331 g (11.7 oz.)
1/16 DIN (PM6)
Controller: 186 g (6.6 oz.)
Wa t l o w E Z - ZO N E PMI C ontrol l er
249
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
P M __ __ __ __ __ - __ __ __ __ __ __ __
Package Size
4
6
8
9
Primary Function
C
R
B
Output 1
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc/open collector
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C
Universal process
Universal process
Universal process
Universal process
None
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
Output 2
None
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Switched dc
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
None
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Switched dc
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
None
Switched dc (cannot use variable time base)
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
NO-ARC 15 A power control
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
A
None
C
6 Digital I/O - Not available with PM6
D
6 Digital I/O and EIA-485 Modbus RTU - Not available with PM6
1
EIA 485 Modbus RTU
2
Modbus RTU 232/485
3
EtherNet/IP, Modbus TCP
5
DeviceNet
6
Profibus DP
7
SAE J1939 CAN bus
C
6 Digital I/O (not available on 1/16 DIN controllers)
D
6 Digital I/O and EIA 485 Modbus RTU (not available on 1/16 DIN controllers)
- Standard Bus EIA-485 always included - all models
A
None
C
2nd PID Channel with Universal Input - Not available on PM6
J
2nd PID Channel with Thermistor Input - Not available on PM6
R
Auxillary 2nd input (Universal Input)
P
Auxillary 2nd input (Thermistor Input)
T
Current Transformer Input (The following options are Not Valid for outputs 3 & 4: FA, FC, FJ and FK)
L
Integrated Limit Controller with Universal Input (Valid options for outputs 3 & 4: CJ, EJ, or AJ only)
M
Integrated Limit Controller with Thermistor Input (Valid options for outputs 3 & 4: CJ, EJ, or AJ only)
- PM6 When ordering Communications Options 2 - 6, option A must be ordered above
Auxillary input can be configured for remote set point, back-up sensor, ratio, differential or wet-bulb/dry-bulb input
Output 3
Output 4
AA None
None
AJ
None
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
AK None
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
CA Switched dc/open collector
None
CC Switched dc/open collector
Switched dc
CH Switched dc/open collector
NO-ARC 15 A power control
CJ
Switched dc/open collector
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
CK Switched dc/open collector
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
EA Mechanical relay 5 A, form C None
EC Mechanical relay 5 A, form C Switched dc
EH Mechanical relay 5 A, form C NO-ARC 15 A power control
EJ
Mechanical relay 5 A, form C Mechanical relay 5 A, form A
EK Mechanical relay 5 A, form C Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
FA
Universal Process
None
FC Universal Process
Switched dc (cannot use variable time base)
FJ
Universal Process
Mechanical relay 5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
FK Universal Process
Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A (cannot use variable time base)
KH Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A NO-ARC 15 A power control
KK Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A Solid-state relay 0.5 A, form A
- With Communications Options 2 - 6, option AA must be ordered with PM6 above
- Output options CH,EH and KH not available with PM6
Additional Options
A
Standard
C
Enhanced firmware including: Compressor Control, Cascade, Ratio, Differential, Square-root, Motorized Valve Control without feedback
D
Standard with isolated input 1, input 2 always isolated
F
Enhanced firmware with isolated input 1, input 2 always isolated
Note: Auxiliary Control Function C or J required for cascade control.
Custom Options
AA
AB
AC
AG
XX
12
250
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x
Declaration of Conformity
Series EZ-ZONE PM
WATLOW Electric Manufacturing Company
2013
EN 61000-4-2
EN 61000-4-3
EN 61000-4-4
EN 61000-4-5
EN 61000-4-6
EN 61000-4-11
EN 61000-3-2
1
EN 61000-3-3
SEMI F47
2009
2010
2012
2006
2014
2004
2009
2013
2000
For mechanical relay loads, cycle time may need to be extended up to 160 seconds to meet flicker
requirements depending on load switched and source impedance.
EN 61010-1
2
20112
Compliance with 3rd Edition requirements with use of external surge suppressor installed on 230 Vac~ power line units.
Recommend minimum 1000 V peak to maximum 2000 V peak, 70 joules or better part be used.
Joe Millanes
Name of Authorized Representative
Director of Operations
Title of Authorized Representative
September 2014
Date of Issue
PMI C ontrol l er
Wa
l o w EEZ-ZONE
Z - ZO N EPM-09-14
CEt DOC
251
Cha pte r 11 A p p e n d i x
How to Reach Us
Corporate Headquarters
Latin America
Europe
Watlow France
Tour d'Asnires.
4 Avenue Laurent Cly
92600 Asnires sur Seine
France
Tl: + 33 (0)1 41 32 79 70
Tlcopie: + 33(0)1 47 33 36 57
Email: info@watlow.fr
Website: www.watlow.fr
Watlow GmbH
Postfach 11 65, Lauchwasenstr. 1
D-76709 Kronau
Germany
Tel: +49 (0) 7253 9400-0
Fax: +49 (0) 7253 9400-900
Email: info@watlow.de
Website: www.watlow.de
Watlow Italy S.r.l.
Viale Italia 52/54
20094 Corsico MI
Italy
Tel: +39 024588841
Fax: +39 0245869954
Email: italyinfo@watlow.com
Website: www.watlow.it
80143 189 10
: 07-2885168
: 07-2885568
Authorized
Watlow Distributor
Tel: Your
+886-7-2885168 Fax:
+886-7-2885568
101-0047 1-14-4
9
Tel: 03-3518-6630
Fax: 03-3518-6632
Email: infoj@watlow.com
Website: www.watlow.co.jp
TOTAL
CUSTOMER
SATISFACTION
3 Year Warranty
252
Cha pte r 11 Ap p e n d i x